xref: /openbmc/linux/include/net/cfg80211.h (revision dc3401c8)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2021 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27 
28 /**
29  * DOC: Introduction
30  *
31  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37  *
38  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39  * use restrictions.
40  */
41 
42 
43 /**
44  * DOC: Device registration
45  *
46  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48  * described below.
49  *
50  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55  * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
56  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59  *
60  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63  */
64 
65 struct wiphy;
66 
67 /*
68  * wireless hardware capability structures
69  */
70 
71 /**
72  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73  *
74  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75  *
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
80  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
81  *	is not permitted.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
83  *	is not permitted.
84  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
85  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
86  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
87  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
88  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
89  *	restrictions.
90  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
91  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
92  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
93  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
94  *	restrictions.
95  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
96  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
97  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
98  *	on this channel.
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
102  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
103  *	on this channel.
104  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105  *	on this channel.
106  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107  *	on this channel.
108  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109  *	on this channel.
110  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111  *	on this channel.
112  *
113  */
114 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
115 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
116 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
117 	/* hole at 1<<2 */
118 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
119 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
120 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
121 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
122 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
123 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
124 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
125 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
126 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
127 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
128 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
129 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
131 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
132 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
133 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
134 };
135 
136 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
137 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
138 
139 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
140 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
141 
142 /**
143  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
144  *
145  * This structure describes a single channel for use
146  * with cfg80211.
147  *
148  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
149  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
150  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
151  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
152  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
153  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
154  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
155  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
156  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
157  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
158  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
159  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
160  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
161  * @orig_mag: internal use
162  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
163  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
164  *	on this channel.
165  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
166  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
167  */
168 struct ieee80211_channel {
169 	enum nl80211_band band;
170 	u32 center_freq;
171 	u16 freq_offset;
172 	u16 hw_value;
173 	u32 flags;
174 	int max_antenna_gain;
175 	int max_power;
176 	int max_reg_power;
177 	bool beacon_found;
178 	u32 orig_flags;
179 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
180 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
181 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
182 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
183 };
184 
185 /**
186  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
187  *
188  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
189  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
190  * different bands/PHY modes.
191  *
192  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
193  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
194  *	with CCK rates.
195  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
196  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
197  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
198  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
199  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
200  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
201  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
202  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
203  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
204  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
205  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
206  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
207  */
208 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
209 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
210 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
211 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
212 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
213 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
214 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
215 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
216 };
217 
218 /**
219  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
220  *
221  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
222  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
223  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
224  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
225  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
226  */
227 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
228 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
229 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
230 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
231 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
232 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
233 };
234 
235 /**
236  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
237  *
238  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
239  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
240  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
241  */
242 enum ieee80211_privacy {
243 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
244 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
245 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
246 };
247 
248 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
249 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
250 
251 /**
252  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
253  *
254  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
255  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
256  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
257  * passed around.
258  *
259  * @flags: rate-specific flags
260  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
261  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
262  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
263  *	short preamble is used
264  */
265 struct ieee80211_rate {
266 	u32 flags;
267 	u16 bitrate;
268 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
269 };
270 
271 /**
272  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
273  *
274  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
275  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
276  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
277  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
278  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
279  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
280  *	members of the SRG
281  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
282  *	used by members of the SRG
283  */
284 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
285 	bool enable;
286 	u8 sr_ctrl;
287 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
288 	u8 min_offset;
289 	u8 max_offset;
290 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
291 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
292 };
293 
294 /**
295  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
296  *
297  * @color: the current color.
298  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
299  * @partial: define the AID equation.
300  */
301 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
302 	u8 color;
303 	bool enabled;
304 	bool partial;
305 };
306 
307 /**
308  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
309  *
310  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
311  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
312  *
313  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
314  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
315  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
316  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
317  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
318  */
319 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
320 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
321 	bool ht_supported;
322 	u8 ampdu_factor;
323 	u8 ampdu_density;
324 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
325 };
326 
327 /**
328  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
329  *
330  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
331  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
332  *
333  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
334  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
335  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
336  */
337 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
338 	bool vht_supported;
339 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
340 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
341 };
342 
343 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
344 
345 /**
346  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
347  *
348  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
349  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
350  *
351  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
352  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
353  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
354  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
355  */
356 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
357 	bool has_he;
358 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
359 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
360 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
361 };
362 
363 /**
364  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
365  *
366  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
367  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
368  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
369  *
370  * @types_mask: interface types mask
371  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
372  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
373  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
374  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
375  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
376  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
377  */
378 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
379 	u16 types_mask;
380 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
381 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
382 	struct {
383 		const u8 *data;
384 		unsigned int len;
385 	} vendor_elems;
386 };
387 
388 /**
389  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
390  *
391  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
392  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
393  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
394  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
395  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
396  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
397  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
398  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
399  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
400  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
401  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
402  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
403  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
404  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
405  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
406  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
407  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
408  */
409 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
410 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
411 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
412 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
413 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
414 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
415 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
416 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
417 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
418 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
419 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
420 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
421 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
422 };
423 
424 /**
425  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
426  *
427  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
428  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
429  *
430  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
431  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
432  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
433  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
434  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
435  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
436  */
437 struct ieee80211_edmg {
438 	u8 channels;
439 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
440 };
441 
442 /**
443  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
444  *
445  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
446  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
447  *
448  * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA
449  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
450  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
451  */
452 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
453 	bool s1g;
454 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
455 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
456 };
457 
458 /**
459  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
460  *
461  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
462  * is able to operate in.
463  *
464  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
465  *	in this band.
466  * @band: the band this structure represents
467  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
468  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
469  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
470  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
471  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
472  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
473  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
474  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
475  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
476  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
477  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
478  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
479  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
480  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
481  *	iftype_data).
482  */
483 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
484 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
485 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
486 	enum nl80211_band band;
487 	int n_channels;
488 	int n_bitrates;
489 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
490 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
491 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
492 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
493 	u16 n_iftype_data;
494 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
495 };
496 
497 /**
498  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
499  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
500  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
501  *
502  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
503  */
504 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
505 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
506 				u8 iftype)
507 {
508 	int i;
509 
510 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
511 		return NULL;
512 
513 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++)  {
514 		const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
515 			&sband->iftype_data[i];
516 
517 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
518 			return data;
519 	}
520 
521 	return NULL;
522 }
523 
524 /**
525  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
526  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
527  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
528  *
529  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
530  */
531 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
532 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
533 			    u8 iftype)
534 {
535 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
536 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
537 
538 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
539 		return &data->he_cap;
540 
541 	return NULL;
542 }
543 
544 /**
545  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
546  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
547  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
548  *
549  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
550  */
551 static inline __le16
552 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
553 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
554 {
555 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
556 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
557 
558 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
559 		return 0;
560 
561 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
562 }
563 
564 /**
565  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
566  *
567  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
568  *
569  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
570  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
571  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
572  *
573  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
574  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
575  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
576  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
577  * without affecting other devices.
578  *
579  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
580  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
581  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
582  */
583 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
584 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
585 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
586 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
587 {
588 }
589 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
590 
591 
592 /*
593  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
594  */
595 
596 /**
597  * DOC: Actions and configuration
598  *
599  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
600  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
601  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
602  * operations use are described separately.
603  *
604  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
605  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
606  *
607  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
608  * in a separate chapter.
609  */
610 
611 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
612 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
613 
614 /**
615  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
616  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
617  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
618  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
619  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
620  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
621  *	determine the address as needed.
622  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
623  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
624  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
625  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
626  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
627  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
628  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
629  */
630 struct vif_params {
631 	u32 flags;
632 	int use_4addr;
633 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
634 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
635 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
636 };
637 
638 /**
639  * struct key_params - key information
640  *
641  * Information about a key
642  *
643  * @key: key material
644  * @key_len: length of key material
645  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
646  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
647  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
648  *	length given by @seq_len.
649  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
650  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
651  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
652  */
653 struct key_params {
654 	const u8 *key;
655 	const u8 *seq;
656 	int key_len;
657 	int seq_len;
658 	u16 vlan_id;
659 	u32 cipher;
660 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
661 };
662 
663 /**
664  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
665  * @chan: the (control) channel
666  * @width: channel width
667  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
668  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
669  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
670  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
671  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
672  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
673  *	parameters are ignored.
674  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
675  */
676 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
677 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
678 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
679 	u32 center_freq1;
680 	u32 center_freq2;
681 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
682 	u16 freq1_offset;
683 };
684 
685 /*
686  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
687  */
688 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
689 	struct {
690 		u32 legacy;
691 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
692 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
693 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
694 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
695 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
696 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
697 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
698 };
699 
700 
701 /**
702  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
703  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
704  *	of the peer.
705  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
706  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
707  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
708  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
709  * @retry_long: retry count value
710  * @retry_short: retry count value
711  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
712  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
713  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
714  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
715  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
716  */
717 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
718 	bool config_override;
719 	u8 tids;
720 	u64 mask;
721 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
722 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
723 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
724 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
725 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
726 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
727 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
728 };
729 
730 /**
731  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
732  * @peer: Station's MAC address
733  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
734  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
735  */
736 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
737 	const u8 *peer;
738 	u32 n_tid_conf;
739 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[];
740 };
741 
742 /**
743  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
744  * @chandef: the channel definition
745  *
746  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
747  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
748  */
749 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
750 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
751 {
752 	switch (chandef->width) {
753 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
754 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
755 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
756 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
757 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
758 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
759 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
760 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
761 	default:
762 		WARN_ON(1);
763 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
764 	}
765 }
766 
767 /**
768  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
769  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
770  * @channel: the control channel
771  * @chantype: the channel type
772  *
773  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
774  */
775 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
776 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
777 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
778 
779 /**
780  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
781  * @chandef1: first channel definition
782  * @chandef2: second channel definition
783  *
784  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
785  * identical, %false otherwise.
786  */
787 static inline bool
788 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
789 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
790 {
791 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
792 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
793 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
794 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
795 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
796 }
797 
798 /**
799  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
800  *
801  * @chandef: the channel definition
802  *
803  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
804  */
805 static inline bool
806 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
807 {
808 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
809 }
810 
811 /**
812  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
813  * @chandef1: first channel definition
814  * @chandef2: second channel definition
815  *
816  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
817  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
818  */
819 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
820 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
821 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
822 
823 /**
824  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
825  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
826  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
827  */
828 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
829 
830 /**
831  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
832  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
833  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
834  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
835  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
836  */
837 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
838 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
839 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
840 
841 /**
842  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
843  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
844  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
845  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
846  * Returns:
847  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
848  */
849 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
850 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
851 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
852 
853 /**
854  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
855  *
856  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
857  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
858  *
859  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
860  *
861  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
862  */
863 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
864 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
865 {
866 	switch (chandef->width) {
867 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
868 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
869 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
870 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
871 	default:
872 		break;
873 	}
874 	return 0;
875 }
876 
877 /**
878  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
879  *
880  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
881  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
882  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
883  *
884  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
885  *
886  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
887  */
888 static inline int
889 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
890 {
891 	switch (chandef->width) {
892 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
893 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
894 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
895 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
896 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
897 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
898 	default:
899 		break;
900 	}
901 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
902 }
903 
904 /**
905  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
906  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
907  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
908  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
909  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
910  */
911 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
912 				  unsigned long band_mask,
913 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
914 
915 /**
916  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
917  *
918  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
919  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
920  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
921  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
922  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
923  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
924  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
925  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
926  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
927  *
928  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
929  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
930  */
931 enum survey_info_flags {
932 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
933 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
934 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
935 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
936 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
937 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
938 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
939 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
940 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
941 };
942 
943 /**
944  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
945  *
946  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
947  *	record to report global statistics
948  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
949  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
950  *	optional
951  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
952  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
953  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
954  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
955  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
956  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
957  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
958  *
959  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
960  *
961  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
962  * channel duty cycle etc.
963  */
964 struct survey_info {
965 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
966 	u64 time;
967 	u64 time_busy;
968 	u64 time_ext_busy;
969 	u64 time_rx;
970 	u64 time_tx;
971 	u64 time_scan;
972 	u64 time_bss_rx;
973 	u32 filled;
974 	s8 noise;
975 };
976 
977 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS	4
978 
979 /**
980  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
981  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
982  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
983  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
984  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
985  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
986  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
987  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
988  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
989  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
990  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
991  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
992  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
993  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
994  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
995  *	protocol frames.
996  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
997  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
998  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
999  *	port for mac80211
1000  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
1001  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
1002  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
1003  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1004  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1005  *	offload)
1006  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1007  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1008  *
1009  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1010  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1011  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1012  *	  such a scenario.
1013  *
1014  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1015  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1016  *
1017  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1018  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1019  *
1020  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1021  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1022  */
1023 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1024 	u32 wpa_versions;
1025 	u32 cipher_group;
1026 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1027 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1028 	int n_akm_suites;
1029 	u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES];
1030 	bool control_port;
1031 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1032 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1033 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1034 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1035 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
1036 	int wep_tx_key;
1037 	const u8 *psk;
1038 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1039 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1040 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1041 };
1042 
1043 /**
1044  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1045  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1046  *	or %NULL if not changed
1047  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1048  *	or %NULL if not changed
1049  * @head_len: length of @head
1050  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1051  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1052  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1053  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1054  *	frames or %NULL
1055  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1056  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1057  *	Response frames or %NULL
1058  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1059  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1060  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1061  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1062  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1063  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1064  *	(measurement type 8)
1065  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1066  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1067  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1068  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1069  */
1070 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1071 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1072 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1073 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1074 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1075 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1076 	const u8 *lci;
1077 	const u8 *civicloc;
1078 	s8 ftm_responder;
1079 
1080 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1081 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1082 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1083 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1084 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1085 	size_t lci_len;
1086 	size_t civicloc_len;
1087 };
1088 
1089 struct mac_address {
1090 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1091 };
1092 
1093 /**
1094  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1095  *
1096  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1097  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1098  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1099  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1100  */
1101 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1102 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1103 	int n_acl_entries;
1104 
1105 	/* Keep it last */
1106 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
1107 };
1108 
1109 /**
1110  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1111  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1112  *
1113  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1114  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1115  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1116  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1117  *	frame headers.
1118  */
1119 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1120 	u32 min_interval;
1121 	u32 max_interval;
1122 	size_t tmpl_len;
1123 	const u8 *tmpl;
1124 };
1125 
1126 /**
1127  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1128  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1129  *
1130  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1131  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1132  *	scanning
1133  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1134  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1135  */
1136 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1137 	u32 interval;
1138 	size_t tmpl_len;
1139 	const u8 *tmpl;
1140 };
1141 
1142 /**
1143  * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
1144  *
1145  * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings
1146  *
1147  * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication
1148  */
1149 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags {
1150 	AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0),
1151 };
1152 
1153 /**
1154  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1155  *
1156  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1157  *
1158  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1159  * @beacon: beacon data
1160  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1161  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1162  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1163  *	user space)
1164  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1165  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1166  * @crypto: crypto settings
1167  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1168  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1169  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1170  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1171  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1172  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1173  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1174  *	MAC address based access control
1175  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1176  *	networks.
1177  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1178  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1179  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1180  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1181  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1182  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1183  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1184  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1185  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1186  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
1187  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1188  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1189  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1190  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1191  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1192  */
1193 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1194 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1195 
1196 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1197 
1198 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1199 	const u8 *ssid;
1200 	size_t ssid_len;
1201 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1202 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1203 	bool privacy;
1204 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1205 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1206 	int inactivity_timeout;
1207 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1208 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1209 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1210 	bool pbss;
1211 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1212 
1213 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1214 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1215 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1216 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1217 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1218 	bool twt_responder;
1219 	u32 flags;
1220 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1221 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1222 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1223 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1224 };
1225 
1226 /**
1227  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1228  *
1229  * Used for channel switch
1230  *
1231  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1232  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1233  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1234  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1235  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1236  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1237  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1238  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1239  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1240  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1241  */
1242 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1243 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1244 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1245 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1246 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1247 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1248 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1249 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1250 	bool radar_required;
1251 	bool block_tx;
1252 	u8 count;
1253 };
1254 
1255 /**
1256  * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1257  *
1258  * Used for bss color change
1259  *
1260  * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1261  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1262  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1263  * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1264  * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1265  * @color: the color used after the change
1266  */
1267 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1268 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1269 	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1270 	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1271 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1272 	u8 count;
1273 	u8 color;
1274 };
1275 
1276 /**
1277  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1278  *
1279  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1280  *
1281  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1282  *	to use for verification
1283  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1284  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1285  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1286  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1287  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1288  *	nl80211_iftype.
1289  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1290  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1291  *	the verification
1292  */
1293 struct iface_combination_params {
1294 	int num_different_channels;
1295 	u8 radar_detect;
1296 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1297 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1298 };
1299 
1300 /**
1301  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1302  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1303  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1304  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1305  *
1306  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1307  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1308  */
1309 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1310 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1311 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1312 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1313 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3),
1314 };
1315 
1316 /**
1317  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1318  *
1319  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1320  *
1321  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1322  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1323  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1324  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1325  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1326  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1327  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1328  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1329  *	per peer TPC.
1330  */
1331 struct sta_txpwr {
1332 	s16 power;
1333 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1334 };
1335 
1336 /**
1337  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1338  *
1339  * Used to change and create a new station.
1340  *
1341  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1342  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1343  *	(or NULL for no change)
1344  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1345  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1346  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1347  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1348  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1349  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1350  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1351  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1352  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1353  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1354  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1355  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1356  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1357  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1358  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1359  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1360  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1361  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1362  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1363  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1364  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1365  *	to unknown)
1366  * @capability: station capability
1367  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1368  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1369  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1370  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1371  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1372  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1373  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1374  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1375  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1376  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1377  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1378  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1379  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1380  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1381  */
1382 struct station_parameters {
1383 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1384 	struct net_device *vlan;
1385 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1386 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1387 	int listen_interval;
1388 	u16 aid;
1389 	u16 vlan_id;
1390 	u16 peer_aid;
1391 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1392 	u8 plink_action;
1393 	u8 plink_state;
1394 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1395 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1396 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1397 	u8 max_sp;
1398 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1399 	u16 capability;
1400 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1401 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1402 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1403 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1404 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1405 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1406 	u8 opmode_notif;
1407 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1408 	int support_p2p_ps;
1409 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1410 	u8 he_capa_len;
1411 	u16 airtime_weight;
1412 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1413 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1414 };
1415 
1416 /**
1417  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1418  *
1419  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1420  *
1421  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1422  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1423  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1424  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1425  */
1426 struct station_del_parameters {
1427 	const u8 *mac;
1428 	u8 subtype;
1429 	u16 reason_code;
1430 };
1431 
1432 /**
1433  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1434  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1435  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1436  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1437  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1438  *	the AP MLME in the device
1439  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1440  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1441  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1442  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1443  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1444  *	supported/used)
1445  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1446  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1447  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1448  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1449  */
1450 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1451 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1452 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1453 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1454 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1455 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1456 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1457 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1458 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1459 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1460 };
1461 
1462 /**
1463  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1464  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1465  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1466  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1467  *
1468  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1469  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1470  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1471  * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1472  * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1473  */
1474 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1475 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1476 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1477 
1478 /**
1479  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1480  *
1481  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1482  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1483  *
1484  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1485  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1486  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1487  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1488  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1489  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1490  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1491  */
1492 enum rate_info_flags {
1493 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1494 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1495 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1496 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1497 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1498 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1499 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1500 };
1501 
1502 /**
1503  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1504  *
1505  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1506  *
1507  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1508  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1509  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1510  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1511  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1512  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1513  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1514  */
1515 enum rate_info_bw {
1516 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1517 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1518 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1519 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1520 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1521 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1522 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1523 };
1524 
1525 /**
1526  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1527  *
1528  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1529  *
1530  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1531  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1532  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1533  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1534  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1535  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1536  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1537  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1538  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1539  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1540  */
1541 struct rate_info {
1542 	u8 flags;
1543 	u8 mcs;
1544 	u16 legacy;
1545 	u8 nss;
1546 	u8 bw;
1547 	u8 he_gi;
1548 	u8 he_dcm;
1549 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1550 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1551 };
1552 
1553 /**
1554  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1555  *
1556  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1557  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1558  *
1559  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1560  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1561  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1562  */
1563 enum bss_param_flags {
1564 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1565 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1566 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1567 };
1568 
1569 /**
1570  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1571  *
1572  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1573  *
1574  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1575  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1576  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1577  */
1578 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1579 	u8 flags;
1580 	u8 dtim_period;
1581 	u16 beacon_interval;
1582 };
1583 
1584 /**
1585  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1586  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1587  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1588  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1589  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1590  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1591  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1592  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1593  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1594  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1595  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1596  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1597  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1598  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1599  */
1600 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1601 	u32 filled;
1602 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1603 	u32 backlog_packets;
1604 	u32 flows;
1605 	u32 drops;
1606 	u32 ecn_marks;
1607 	u32 overlimit;
1608 	u32 overmemory;
1609 	u32 collisions;
1610 	u32 tx_bytes;
1611 	u32 tx_packets;
1612 	u32 max_flows;
1613 };
1614 
1615 /**
1616  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1617  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1618  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1619  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1620  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1621  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1622  *	transmitted MSDUs
1623  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1624  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1625  */
1626 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1627 	u32 filled;
1628 	u64 rx_msdu;
1629 	u64 tx_msdu;
1630 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1631 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1632 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1633 };
1634 
1635 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1636 
1637 /**
1638  * struct station_info - station information
1639  *
1640  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1641  *
1642  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1643  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1644  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1645  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1646  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1647  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1648  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1649  * @llid: mesh local link id
1650  * @plid: mesh peer link id
1651  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1652  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1653  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1654  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1655  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1656  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1657  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1658  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1659  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1660  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1661  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1662  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1663  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1664  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1665  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
1666  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1667  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1668  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
1669  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1670  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1671  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1672  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1673  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1674  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1675  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1676  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1677  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1678  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1679  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1680  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1681  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1682  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1683  *	towards this station.
1684  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1685  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1686  *	from this peer
1687  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1688  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1689  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1690  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1691  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1692  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1693  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1694  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1695  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1696  *	been sent.
1697  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1698  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1699  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1700  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1701  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1702  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
1703  */
1704 struct station_info {
1705 	u64 filled;
1706 	u32 connected_time;
1707 	u32 inactive_time;
1708 	u64 assoc_at;
1709 	u64 rx_bytes;
1710 	u64 tx_bytes;
1711 	u16 llid;
1712 	u16 plid;
1713 	u8 plink_state;
1714 	s8 signal;
1715 	s8 signal_avg;
1716 
1717 	u8 chains;
1718 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1719 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1720 
1721 	struct rate_info txrate;
1722 	struct rate_info rxrate;
1723 	u32 rx_packets;
1724 	u32 tx_packets;
1725 	u32 tx_retries;
1726 	u32 tx_failed;
1727 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1728 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1729 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1730 
1731 	int generation;
1732 
1733 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1734 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1735 
1736 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
1737 	s64 t_offset;
1738 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1739 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1740 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1741 
1742 	u32 expected_throughput;
1743 
1744 	u64 tx_duration;
1745 	u64 rx_duration;
1746 	u64 rx_beacon;
1747 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1748 	u8 connected_to_gate;
1749 
1750 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1751 	s8 ack_signal;
1752 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
1753 
1754 	u16 airtime_weight;
1755 
1756 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1757 	u32 fcs_err_count;
1758 
1759 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
1760 
1761 	u8 connected_to_as;
1762 };
1763 
1764 /**
1765  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
1766  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
1767  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
1768  */
1769 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
1770 	s32 power;
1771 	u32 freq_range_index;
1772 };
1773 
1774 /**
1775  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
1776  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
1777  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
1778  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
1779  */
1780 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
1781 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
1782 	u32 num_sub_specs;
1783 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
1784 };
1785 
1786 
1787 /**
1788  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
1789  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
1790  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
1791  */
1792 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
1793 	u32 start_freq;
1794 	u32 end_freq;
1795 };
1796 
1797 /**
1798  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
1799  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
1800  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
1801  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
1802  *
1803  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
1804  * range to small ones and then append them.
1805  */
1806 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
1807 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
1808 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
1809 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
1810 };
1811 
1812 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
1813 /**
1814  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
1815  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
1816  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
1817  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
1818  *
1819  * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
1820  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
1821  * considered undefined.
1822  */
1823 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
1824 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
1825 #else
1826 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
1827 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
1828 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
1829 {
1830 	return -ENOENT;
1831 }
1832 #endif
1833 
1834 /**
1835  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
1836  *
1837  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
1838  * according to the nl80211 flags.
1839  *
1840  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
1841  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
1842  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
1843  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
1844  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
1845  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
1846  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
1847  */
1848 enum monitor_flags {
1849 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
1850 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
1851 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
1852 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
1853 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
1854 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
1855 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
1856 };
1857 
1858 /**
1859  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
1860  *
1861  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
1862  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
1863  *
1864  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
1865  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
1866  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
1867  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
1868  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
1869  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
1870  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
1871  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
1872  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
1873  */
1874 enum mpath_info_flags {
1875 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
1876 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
1877 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
1878 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
1879 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
1880 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
1881 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
1882 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
1883 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
1884 };
1885 
1886 /**
1887  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
1888  *
1889  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
1890  *
1891  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
1892  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
1893  * @sn: target sequence number
1894  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
1895  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
1896  * @flags: mesh path flags
1897  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
1898  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
1899  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1900  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
1901  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1902  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1903  * @hop_count: hops to destination
1904  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
1905  */
1906 struct mpath_info {
1907 	u32 filled;
1908 	u32 frame_qlen;
1909 	u32 sn;
1910 	u32 metric;
1911 	u32 exptime;
1912 	u32 discovery_timeout;
1913 	u8 discovery_retries;
1914 	u8 flags;
1915 	u8 hop_count;
1916 	u32 path_change_count;
1917 
1918 	int generation;
1919 };
1920 
1921 /**
1922  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
1923  *
1924  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
1925  *
1926  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
1927  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1928  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
1929  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1930  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
1931  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1932  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1933  *	(or NULL for no change)
1934  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
1935  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
1936  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1937  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
1938  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
1939  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
1940  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
1941  */
1942 struct bss_parameters {
1943 	int use_cts_prot;
1944 	int use_short_preamble;
1945 	int use_short_slot_time;
1946 	const u8 *basic_rates;
1947 	u8 basic_rates_len;
1948 	int ap_isolate;
1949 	int ht_opmode;
1950 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
1951 };
1952 
1953 /**
1954  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
1955  *
1956  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
1957  *
1958  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
1959  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
1960  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
1961  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
1962  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
1963  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
1964  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
1965  *	mesh interface
1966  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
1967  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
1968  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
1969  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
1970  *	elements
1971  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
1972  *	detect compatible mesh peers
1973  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
1974  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
1975  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
1976  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
1977  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
1978  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
1979  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
1980  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1981  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
1982  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
1983  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1984  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
1985  *	element
1986  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1987  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
1988  *	element
1989  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
1990  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
1991  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
1992  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
1993  *	announcements are transmitted
1994  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
1995  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
1996  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
1997  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
1998  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
1999  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2000  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2001  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2002  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2003  *	station to establish a peer link
2004  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2005  *
2006  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2007  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2008  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2009  *
2010  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2011  *	PREQs are transmitted.
2012  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2013  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2014  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2015  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2016  *	setting for new peer links.
2017  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2018  *	after transmitting its beacon.
2019  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2020  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2021  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2022  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2023  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2024  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2025  *      in the mesh path table
2026  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2027  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2028  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2029  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2030  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2031  */
2032 struct mesh_config {
2033 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2034 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2035 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2036 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2037 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2038 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2039 	u8 element_ttl;
2040 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2041 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2042 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2043 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2044 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2045 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2046 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2047 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2048 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2049 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2050 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2051 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2052 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2053 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2054 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2055 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2056 	u16 ht_opmode;
2057 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2058 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2059 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2060 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2061 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2062 	u32 plink_timeout;
2063 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2064 };
2065 
2066 /**
2067  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2068  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2069  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2070  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2071  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2072  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2073  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2074  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2075  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2076  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2077  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2078  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2079  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2080  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2081  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2082  * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2083  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2084  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2085  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2086  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2087  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2088  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2089  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2090  *
2091  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2092  */
2093 struct mesh_setup {
2094 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2095 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2096 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2097 	u8 sync_method;
2098 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2099 	u8 path_metric;
2100 	u8 auth_id;
2101 	const u8 *ie;
2102 	u8 ie_len;
2103 	bool is_authenticated;
2104 	bool is_secure;
2105 	bool user_mpm;
2106 	u8 dtim_period;
2107 	u16 beacon_interval;
2108 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2109 	u32 basic_rates;
2110 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2111 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2112 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2113 };
2114 
2115 /**
2116  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2117  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2118  *
2119  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2120  */
2121 struct ocb_setup {
2122 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2123 };
2124 
2125 /**
2126  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2127  * @ac: AC identifier
2128  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2129  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2130  *	1..32767]
2131  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2132  *	1..32767]
2133  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2134  */
2135 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2136 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2137 	u16 txop;
2138 	u16 cwmin;
2139 	u16 cwmax;
2140 	u8 aifs;
2141 };
2142 
2143 /**
2144  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2145  *
2146  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2147  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2148  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2149  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2150  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2151  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2152  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2153  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2154  * in the wiphy structure.
2155  *
2156  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2157  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2158  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2159  *
2160  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2161  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2162  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2163  * to userspace.
2164  */
2165 
2166 /**
2167  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2168  * @ssid: the SSID
2169  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2170  */
2171 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2172 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2173 	u8 ssid_len;
2174 };
2175 
2176 /**
2177  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2178  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2179  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2180  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2181  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2182  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2183  *	userspace will be notified of that
2184  */
2185 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2186 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2187 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2188 	bool aborted;
2189 };
2190 
2191 /**
2192  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2193  *
2194  * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for
2195  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2196  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2197  *	 which the above info relvant to
2198  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2199  * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used
2200  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2201  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2202  */
2203 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2204 	u32 short_ssid;
2205 	u32 channel_idx;
2206 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2207 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2208 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2209 	bool psc_no_listen;
2210 };
2211 
2212 /**
2213  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2214  *
2215  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2216  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2217  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2218  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2219  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2220  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2221  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2222  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2223  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2224  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2225  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2226  *	%duration field.
2227  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2228  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2229  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2230  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2231  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2232  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2233  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2234  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2235  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2236  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2237  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2238  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2239  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2240  *	true if this is the second scan request
2241  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2242  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2243  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2244  */
2245 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2246 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2247 	int n_ssids;
2248 	u32 n_channels;
2249 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2250 	const u8 *ie;
2251 	size_t ie_len;
2252 	u16 duration;
2253 	bool duration_mandatory;
2254 	u32 flags;
2255 
2256 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2257 
2258 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2259 
2260 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2261 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2262 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2263 
2264 	/* internal */
2265 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2266 	unsigned long scan_start;
2267 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2268 	bool notified;
2269 	bool no_cck;
2270 	bool scan_6ghz;
2271 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2272 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2273 
2274 	/* keep last */
2275 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2276 };
2277 
2278 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2279 {
2280 	int i;
2281 
2282 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2283 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2284 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2285 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2286 	}
2287 }
2288 
2289 /**
2290  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2291  *
2292  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2293  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2294  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2295  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2296  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2297  * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2298  *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
2299  *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2300  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2301  *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2302  *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2303  *	corresponding matchset.
2304  */
2305 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2306 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2307 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2308 	s32 rssi_thold;
2309 	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2310 };
2311 
2312 /**
2313  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2314  *
2315  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2316  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2317  *	infinite loop.
2318  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2319  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2320  */
2321 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2322 	u32 interval;
2323 	u32 iterations;
2324 };
2325 
2326 /**
2327  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2328  *
2329  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2330  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2331  */
2332 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2333 	enum nl80211_band band;
2334 	s8 delta;
2335 };
2336 
2337 /**
2338  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2339  *
2340  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2341  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2342  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2343  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2344  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2345  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2346  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2347  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2348  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2349  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2350  *	(others are filtered out).
2351  *	If ommited, all results are passed.
2352  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2353  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2354  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2355  * @dev: the interface
2356  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2357  * @channels: channels to scan
2358  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2359  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2360  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2361  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2362  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2363  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2364  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2365  *	index must be executed first.
2366  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2367  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2368  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2369  *	owned by a particular socket)
2370  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2371  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2372  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2373  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2374  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2375  *	supported.
2376  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2377  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2378  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2379  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2380  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2381  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2382  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2383  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2384  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2385  *	comparisions.
2386  */
2387 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2388 	u64 reqid;
2389 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2390 	int n_ssids;
2391 	u32 n_channels;
2392 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2393 	const u8 *ie;
2394 	size_t ie_len;
2395 	u32 flags;
2396 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2397 	int n_match_sets;
2398 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2399 	u32 delay;
2400 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2401 	int n_scan_plans;
2402 
2403 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2404 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2405 
2406 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2407 	s8 relative_rssi;
2408 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2409 
2410 	/* internal */
2411 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2412 	struct net_device *dev;
2413 	unsigned long scan_start;
2414 	bool report_results;
2415 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2416 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2417 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2418 	struct list_head list;
2419 
2420 	/* keep last */
2421 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2422 };
2423 
2424 /**
2425  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2426  *
2427  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2428  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2429  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2430  */
2431 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2432 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2433 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2434 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2435 };
2436 
2437 /**
2438  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2439  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2440  * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2441  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2442  *	signal type
2443  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2444  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2445  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2446  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2447  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2448  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2449  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2450  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2451  *	by %parent_bssid.
2452  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2453  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2454  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2455  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2456  */
2457 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2458 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2459 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2460 	s32 signal;
2461 	u64 boottime_ns;
2462 	u64 parent_tsf;
2463 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2464 	u8 chains;
2465 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2466 };
2467 
2468 /**
2469  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2470  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2471  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2472  * @len: length of the IEs
2473  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2474  * @data: IE data
2475  */
2476 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2477 	u64 tsf;
2478 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2479 	int len;
2480 	bool from_beacon;
2481 	u8 data[];
2482 };
2483 
2484 /**
2485  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2486  *
2487  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2488  * for use in scan results and similar.
2489  *
2490  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2491  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2492  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2493  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2494  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2495  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2496  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2497  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2498  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2499  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2500  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2501  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2502  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2503  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2504  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2505  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2506  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2507  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2508  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2509  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2510  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2511  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2512  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2513  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2514  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2515  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2516  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2517  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2518  */
2519 struct cfg80211_bss {
2520 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2521 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2522 
2523 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2524 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2525 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2526 
2527 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2528 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2529 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2530 
2531 	s32 signal;
2532 
2533 	u16 beacon_interval;
2534 	u16 capability;
2535 
2536 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2537 	u8 chains;
2538 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2539 
2540 	u8 bssid_index;
2541 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2542 
2543 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2544 };
2545 
2546 /**
2547  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2548  * @bss: the bss to search
2549  * @id: the element ID
2550  *
2551  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2552  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2553  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2554  */
2555 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2556 
2557 /**
2558  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2559  * @bss: the bss to search
2560  * @id: the element ID
2561  *
2562  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2563  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2564  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2565  */
2566 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2567 {
2568 	return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2569 }
2570 
2571 
2572 /**
2573  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2574  *
2575  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2576  * authentication.
2577  *
2578  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2579  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2580  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2581  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2582  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2583  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2584  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2585  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2586  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2587  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2588  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2589  *	transaction sequence number field.
2590  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2591  */
2592 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2593 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2594 	const u8 *ie;
2595 	size_t ie_len;
2596 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2597 	const u8 *key;
2598 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2599 	const u8 *auth_data;
2600 	size_t auth_data_len;
2601 };
2602 
2603 /**
2604  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2605  *
2606  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
2607  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
2608  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2609  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2610  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2611  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2612  *	request (connect callback).
2613  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
2614  */
2615 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2616 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
2617 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
2618 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
2619 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
2620 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
2621 };
2622 
2623 /**
2624  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2625  *
2626  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2627  * (re)association.
2628  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2629  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2630  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2631  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
2632  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2633  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2634  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2635  * @crypto: crypto settings
2636  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2637  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2638  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2639  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2640  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2641  *	frame.
2642  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2643  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2644  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2645  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2646  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2647  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2648  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2649  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
2650  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2651  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2652  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2653  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2654  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
2655  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
2656  */
2657 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2658 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2659 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2660 	size_t ie_len;
2661 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2662 	bool use_mfp;
2663 	u32 flags;
2664 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2665 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2666 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2667 	const u8 *fils_kek;
2668 	size_t fils_kek_len;
2669 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
2670 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
2671 };
2672 
2673 /**
2674  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2675  *
2676  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2677  * deauthentication.
2678  *
2679  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from
2680  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2681  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2682  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2683  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2684  *	do not set a deauth frame
2685  */
2686 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2687 	const u8 *bssid;
2688 	const u8 *ie;
2689 	size_t ie_len;
2690 	u16 reason_code;
2691 	bool local_state_change;
2692 };
2693 
2694 /**
2695  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2696  *
2697  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2698  * disassociation.
2699  *
2700  * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from
2701  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2702  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2703  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2704  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2705  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2706  */
2707 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2708 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2709 	const u8 *ie;
2710 	size_t ie_len;
2711 	u16 reason_code;
2712 	bool local_state_change;
2713 };
2714 
2715 /**
2716  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
2717  *
2718  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
2719  * method.
2720  *
2721  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
2722  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
2723  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
2724  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
2725  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
2726  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
2727  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
2728  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
2729  * @ie_len: length of that
2730  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2731  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
2732  *	after joining
2733  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
2734  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
2735  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
2736  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
2737  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2738  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2739  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2740  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2741  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2742  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
2743  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
2744  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2745  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2746  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2747  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
2748  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
2749  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
2750  */
2751 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
2752 	const u8 *ssid;
2753 	const u8 *bssid;
2754 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2755 	const u8 *ie;
2756 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
2757 	u16 beacon_interval;
2758 	u32 basic_rates;
2759 	bool channel_fixed;
2760 	bool privacy;
2761 	bool control_port;
2762 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2763 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2764 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2765 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2766 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2767 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
2768 	int wep_tx_key;
2769 };
2770 
2771 /**
2772  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
2773  *
2774  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
2775  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
2776  * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
2777  * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
2778  */
2779 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
2780 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
2781 	union {
2782 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
2783 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
2784 	} param;
2785 };
2786 
2787 /**
2788  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
2789  *
2790  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2791  * authentication and association.
2792  *
2793  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
2794  *	on scan results)
2795  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
2796  *	%NULL if not specified
2797  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
2798  *	results)
2799  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
2800  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
2801  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
2802  *	to use.
2803  * @ssid: SSID
2804  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
2805  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2806  * @ie: IEs for association request
2807  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
2808  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
2809  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
2810  * @crypto: crypto settings
2811  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2812  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2813  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2814  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2815  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
2816  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
2817  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2818  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2819  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2820  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
2821  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
2822  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
2823  *	networks.
2824  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
2825  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2826  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2827  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2828  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2829  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2830  *	frame.
2831  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
2832  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
2833  *	data IE.
2834  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
2835  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
2836  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
2837  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2838  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
2839  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
2840  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2841  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
2842  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
2843  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
2844  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
2845  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
2846  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
2847  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
2848  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
2849  */
2850 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
2851 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2852 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
2853 	const u8 *bssid;
2854 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
2855 	const u8 *ssid;
2856 	size_t ssid_len;
2857 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2858 	const u8 *ie;
2859 	size_t ie_len;
2860 	bool privacy;
2861 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
2862 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2863 	const u8 *key;
2864 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2865 	u32 flags;
2866 	int bg_scan_period;
2867 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2868 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2869 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
2870 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
2871 	bool pbss;
2872 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
2873 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
2874 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
2875 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
2876 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
2877 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
2878 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
2879 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
2880 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
2881 	bool want_1x;
2882 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
2883 };
2884 
2885 /**
2886  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
2887  *
2888  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
2889  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
2890  *
2891  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
2892  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
2893  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
2894  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
2895  */
2896 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
2897 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
2898 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
2899 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
2900 };
2901 
2902 /**
2903  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
2904  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
2905  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
2906  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
2907  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
2908  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
2909  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
2910  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
2911  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
2912  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
2913  */
2914 enum wiphy_params_flags {
2915 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
2916 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
2917 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
2918 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
2919 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
2920 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
2921 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
2922 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
2923 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
2924 };
2925 
2926 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
2927 
2928 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
2929 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
2930 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
2931 
2932 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
2933 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
2934 
2935 /**
2936  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
2937  *
2938  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
2939  * caching.
2940  *
2941  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
2942  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
2943  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
2944  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
2945  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
2946  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
2947  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
2948  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
2949  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
2950  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
2951  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
2952  *	%NULL).
2953  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
2954  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
2955  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
2956  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
2957  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
2958  *	used for it expires.
2959  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
2960  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
2961  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
2962  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
2963  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
2964  */
2965 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
2966 	const u8 *bssid;
2967 	const u8 *pmkid;
2968 	const u8 *pmk;
2969 	size_t pmk_len;
2970 	const u8 *ssid;
2971 	size_t ssid_len;
2972 	const u8 *cache_id;
2973 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
2974 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
2975 };
2976 
2977 /**
2978  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
2979  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
2980  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
2981  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
2982  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
2983  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
2984  *
2985  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
2986  * memory, free @mask only!
2987  */
2988 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
2989 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
2990 	int pattern_len;
2991 	int pkt_offset;
2992 };
2993 
2994 /**
2995  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
2996  *
2997  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
2998  * @src: source IP address
2999  * @dst: destination IP address
3000  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3001  * @src_port: source port
3002  * @dst_port: destination port
3003  * @payload_len: data payload length
3004  * @payload: data payload buffer
3005  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3006  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3007  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3008  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3009  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3010  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3011  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3012  */
3013 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3014 	struct socket *sock;
3015 	__be32 src, dst;
3016 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3017 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3018 	int payload_len;
3019 	const u8 *payload;
3020 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3021 	u32 data_interval;
3022 	u32 wake_len;
3023 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3024 	u32 tokens_size;
3025 	/* must be last, variable member */
3026 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3027 };
3028 
3029 /**
3030  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3031  *
3032  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3033  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3034  *	operating as normal during suspend
3035  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3036  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3037  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3038  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3039  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3040  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3041  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3042  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3043  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3044  *	NULL if not configured.
3045  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3046  */
3047 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3048 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3049 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3050 	     rfkill_release;
3051 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3052 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3053 	int n_patterns;
3054 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3055 };
3056 
3057 /**
3058  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3059  *
3060  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3061  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3062  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3063  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3064  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3065  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3066  */
3067 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3068 	int delay;
3069 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3070 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3071 	int n_patterns;
3072 };
3073 
3074 /**
3075  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3076  *
3077  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3078  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3079  * @n_rules: number of rules
3080  */
3081 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3082 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3083 	int n_rules;
3084 };
3085 
3086 /**
3087  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3088  *
3089  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3090  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3091  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3092  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3093  *	occurred (in MHz)
3094  */
3095 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3096 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3097 	int n_channels;
3098 	u32 channels[];
3099 };
3100 
3101 /**
3102  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3103  *
3104  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3105  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3106  *	match information.
3107  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3108  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3109  */
3110 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3111 	int n_matches;
3112 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3113 };
3114 
3115 /**
3116  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3117  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3118  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3119  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3120  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3121  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3122  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3123  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3124  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3125  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3126  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3127  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3128  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3129  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3130  *	it is.
3131  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3132  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3133  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3134  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3135  */
3136 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3137 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3138 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3139 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3140 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3141 	s32 pattern_idx;
3142 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3143 	const void *packet;
3144 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3145 };
3146 
3147 /**
3148  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3149  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3150  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3151  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3152  * @kek_len: length of kek
3153  * @kck_len length of kck
3154  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3155  */
3156 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3157 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3158 	u32 akm;
3159 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3160 };
3161 
3162 /**
3163  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3164  *
3165  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3166  *
3167  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3168  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3169  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3170  */
3171 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3172 	u16 md;
3173 	const u8 *ie;
3174 	size_t ie_len;
3175 };
3176 
3177 /**
3178  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3179  *
3180  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3181  *
3182  * @chan: channel to use
3183  * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
3184  * @wait: duration for ROC
3185  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3186  * @len: buffer length
3187  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3188  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3189  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3190  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3191  */
3192 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3193 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3194 	bool offchan;
3195 	unsigned int wait;
3196 	const u8 *buf;
3197 	size_t len;
3198 	bool no_cck;
3199 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3200 	int n_csa_offsets;
3201 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3202 };
3203 
3204 /**
3205  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3206  *
3207  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3208  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3209  */
3210 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3211 	u8 dscp;
3212 	u8 up;
3213 };
3214 
3215 /**
3216  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3217  *
3218  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3219  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3220  */
3221 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3222 	u8 low;
3223 	u8 high;
3224 };
3225 
3226 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3227 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3228 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3229 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3230 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3231 
3232 /**
3233  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3234  *
3235  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3236  *
3237  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3238  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3239  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3240  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3241  */
3242 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3243 	u8 num_des;
3244 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3245 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3246 };
3247 
3248 /**
3249  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3250  *
3251  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3252  *
3253  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3254  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3255  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3256  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3257  */
3258 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3259 	u8 master_pref;
3260 	u8 bands;
3261 };
3262 
3263 /**
3264  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3265  * configuration
3266  *
3267  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3268  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3269  */
3270 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3271 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3272 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3273 };
3274 
3275 /**
3276  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3277  *
3278  * @filter: the content of the filter
3279  * @len: the length of the filter
3280  */
3281 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3282 	const u8 *filter;
3283 	u8 len;
3284 };
3285 
3286 /**
3287  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3288  *
3289  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3290  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3291  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3292  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3293  *	implementation specific.
3294  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3295  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3296  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3297  * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
3298  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3299  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3300  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3301  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3302  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3303  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3304  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3305  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3306  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3307  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3308  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3309  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3310  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3311  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3312  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3313  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3314  */
3315 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3316 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3317 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3318 	u8 publish_type;
3319 	bool close_range;
3320 	bool publish_bcast;
3321 	bool subscribe_active;
3322 	u8 followup_id;
3323 	u8 followup_reqid;
3324 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3325 	u32 ttl;
3326 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3327 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3328 	bool srf_include;
3329 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3330 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3331 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3332 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3333 	int srf_num_macs;
3334 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3335 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3336 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3337 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3338 	u8 instance_id;
3339 	u64 cookie;
3340 };
3341 
3342 /**
3343  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3344  *
3345  * @aa: authenticator address
3346  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3347  * @pmk: the PMK material
3348  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3349  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3350  *	holds PMK-R0.
3351  */
3352 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3353 	const u8 *aa;
3354 	u8 pmk_len;
3355 	const u8 *pmk;
3356 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3357 };
3358 
3359 /**
3360  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3361  *
3362  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3363  *
3364  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3365  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3366  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3367  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3368  *	authentication response command interface.
3369  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3370  *	authentication response command interface.
3371  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3372  *	authentication request event interface.
3373  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3374  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3375  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3376  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3377  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3378  */
3379 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3380 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3381 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3382 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3383 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3384 	u16 status;
3385 	const u8 *pmkid;
3386 };
3387 
3388 /**
3389  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3390  *
3391  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3392  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3393  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3394  *	answered
3395  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3396  *	successfully answered
3397  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3398  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3399  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3400  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3401  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3402  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3403  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3404  *	the responder
3405  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3406  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3407  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3408  */
3409 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3410 	u32 filled;
3411 	u32 success_num;
3412 	u32 partial_num;
3413 	u32 failed_num;
3414 	u32 asap_num;
3415 	u32 non_asap_num;
3416 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3417 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3418 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3419 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3420 };
3421 
3422 /**
3423  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3424  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3425  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3426  *	reason than just "failure"
3427  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3428  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3429  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3430  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3431  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3432  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3433  *	by the responder
3434  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3435  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3436  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3437  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3438  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3439  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3440  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3441  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3442  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3443  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3444  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3445  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3446  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3447  *	the square root of the variance)
3448  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3449  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3450  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3451  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3452  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3453  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3454  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3455  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3456  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3457  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3458  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3459  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3460  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3461  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3462  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3463  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3464  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3465  */
3466 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3467 	const u8 *lci;
3468 	const u8 *civicloc;
3469 	unsigned int lci_len;
3470 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3471 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3472 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3473 	s16 burst_index;
3474 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3475 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3476 	u8 burst_duration;
3477 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3478 	s32 rssi_avg;
3479 	s32 rssi_spread;
3480 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3481 	s64 rtt_avg;
3482 	s64 rtt_variance;
3483 	s64 rtt_spread;
3484 	s64 dist_avg;
3485 	s64 dist_variance;
3486 	s64 dist_spread;
3487 
3488 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3489 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3490 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3491 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3492 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3493 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3494 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3495 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3496 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3497 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3498 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3499 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3500 };
3501 
3502 /**
3503  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3504  * @addr: address of the peer
3505  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3506  *	measurement was made)
3507  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3508  * @status: status of the measurement
3509  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3510  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3511  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3512  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3513  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3514  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3515  */
3516 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3517 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3518 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3519 
3520 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3521 
3522 	u8 final:1,
3523 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3524 
3525 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3526 
3527 	union {
3528 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3529 	};
3530 };
3531 
3532 /**
3533  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3534  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3535  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3536  * @burst_period: burst period to use
3537  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3538  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3539  * @burst_duration: burst duration
3540  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3541  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3542  * @request_lci: request LCI information
3543  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3544  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3545  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3546  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3547  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3548  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3549  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3550  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
3551  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
3552  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
3553  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
3554  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
3555  *
3556  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3557  */
3558 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3559 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3560 	u16 burst_period;
3561 	u8 requested:1,
3562 	   asap:1,
3563 	   request_lci:1,
3564 	   request_civicloc:1,
3565 	   trigger_based:1,
3566 	   non_trigger_based:1,
3567 	   lmr_feedback:1;
3568 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3569 	u8 burst_duration;
3570 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3571 	u8 ftmr_retries;
3572 	u8 bss_color;
3573 };
3574 
3575 /**
3576  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3577  * @addr: MAC address
3578  * @chandef: channel to use
3579  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3580  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3581  */
3582 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3583 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3584 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3585 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3586 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3587 };
3588 
3589 /**
3590  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3591  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3592  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3593  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3594  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3595  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3596  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3597  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3598  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
3599  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3600  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3601  *	zero it means there's no timeout
3602  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3603  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3604  */
3605 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3606 	u64 cookie;
3607 	void *drv_data;
3608 	u32 n_peers;
3609 	u32 nl_portid;
3610 
3611 	u32 timeout;
3612 
3613 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3614 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3615 
3616 	struct list_head list;
3617 
3618 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3619 };
3620 
3621 /**
3622  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3623  *
3624  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3625  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3626  *
3627  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3628  *
3629  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3630  *	has to be done.
3631  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3632  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3633  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3634  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3635  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3636  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3637  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3638  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
3639  */
3640 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3641 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3642 	u16 status;
3643 	const u8 *ie;
3644 	size_t ie_len;
3645 };
3646 
3647 /**
3648  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
3649  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3650  *	for the entire device
3651  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3652  *	for the given interface
3653  * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
3654  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
3655  *	for these subtypes
3656  */
3657 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
3658 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
3659 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
3660 };
3661 
3662 /**
3663  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3664  *
3665  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3666  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3667  *
3668  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3669  * on success or a negative error code.
3670  *
3671  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
3672  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
3673  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
3674  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
3675  *
3676  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3677  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
3678  *	configured for the device.
3679  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
3680  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
3681  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
3682  *	the device.
3683  *
3684  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
3685  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
3686  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
3687  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
3688  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
3689  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3690  *
3691  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
3692  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3693  *
3694  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
3695  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
3696  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3697  *
3698  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
3699  *	when adding a group key.
3700  *
3701  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
3702  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
3703  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
3704  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
3705  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
3706  *
3707  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
3708  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist.
3709  *
3710  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface
3711  *
3712  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface
3713  *
3714  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface
3715  *
3716  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
3717  *
3718  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
3719  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
3720  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
3721  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
3722  *
3723  * @add_station: Add a new station.
3724  * @del_station: Remove a station
3725  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
3726  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
3727  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
3728  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
3729  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
3730  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
3731  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3732  *
3733  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
3734  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
3735  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
3736  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
3737  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3738  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
3739  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3740  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
3741  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3742  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
3743  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3744  *
3745  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
3746  *
3747  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
3748  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
3749  *	set, and which to leave alone.
3750  *
3751  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
3752  *
3753  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
3754  *
3755  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
3756  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
3757  *	join the mesh instead.
3758  *
3759  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
3760  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
3761  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
3762  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
3763  *
3764  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
3765  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
3766  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
3767  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
3768  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
3769  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
3770  *
3771  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
3772  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3773  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
3774  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3775  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
3776  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3777  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
3778  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3779  *
3780  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
3781  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
3782  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
3783  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
3784  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
3785  *	was received.
3786  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
3787  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
3788  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
3789  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
3790  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
3791  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
3792  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
3793  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
3794  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
3795  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
3796  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
3797  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3798  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
3799  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
3800  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
3801  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
3802  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
3803  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
3804  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
3805  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3806  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
3807  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
3808  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
3809  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
3810  *
3811  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
3812  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
3813  *	to a merge.
3814  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3815  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
3816  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3817  *
3818  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
3819  *	MESH mode)
3820  *
3821  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
3822  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
3823  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
3824  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
3825  *
3826  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
3827  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
3828  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
3829  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
3830  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
3831  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
3832  *	return 0 if successful
3833  *
3834  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
3835  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
3836  *
3837  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
3838  *
3839  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
3840  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
3841  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
3842  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
3843  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
3844  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
3845  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
3846  *	the duration value.
3847  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
3848  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
3849  *	frame on another channel
3850  *
3851  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
3852  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
3853  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
3854  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
3855  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
3856  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
3857  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
3858  *
3859  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
3860  *
3861  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
3862  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
3863  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
3864  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
3865  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
3866  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
3867  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
3868  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
3869  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
3870  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
3871  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
3872  *	disabled.)
3873  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
3874  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
3875  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
3876  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
3877  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
3878  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
3879  *	thresholds.
3880  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
3881  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
3882  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
3883  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
3884  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
3885  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
3886  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
3887  *
3888  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
3889  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
3890  *
3891  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3892  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3893  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3894  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3895  *
3896  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3897  *
3898  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
3899  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
3900  *
3901  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
3902  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
3903  *
3904  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
3905  *
3906  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
3907  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
3908  *	current monitoring channel.
3909  *
3910  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
3911  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
3912  *
3913  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
3914  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
3915  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
3916  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
3917  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
3918  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
3919  *
3920  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
3921  *
3922  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
3923  *	was finished on another phy.
3924  *
3925  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
3926  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
3927  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
3928  *
3929  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
3930  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
3931  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
3932  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
3933  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
3934  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
3935  *
3936  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
3937  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
3938  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
3939  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
3940  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
3941  *	as soon as possible.
3942  *
3943  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
3944  *
3945  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
3946  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
3947  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
3948  *
3949  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
3950  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
3951  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
3952  *	account.
3953  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
3954  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
3955  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
3956  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
3957  *	rejected)
3958  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
3959  *
3960  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
3961  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3962  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
3963  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3964  *
3965  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3966  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3967  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
3968  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3969  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3970  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
3971  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
3972  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
3973  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
3974  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
3975  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
3976  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
3977  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
3978  *	provided @nan_func.
3979  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
3980  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
3981  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
3982  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
3983  *
3984  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
3985  *
3986  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
3987  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
3988  *
3989  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
3990  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
3991  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
3992  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3993  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
3994  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3995  *
3996  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
3997  *     user space
3998  *
3999  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4000  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4001  *
4002  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4003  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4004  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4005  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4006  *
4007  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4008  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4009  *	DH IE through this interface.
4010  *
4011  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4012  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4013  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4014  *	This callback may sleep.
4015  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4016  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4017  *
4018  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4019  *
4020  * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4021  */
4022 struct cfg80211_ops {
4023 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4024 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4025 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4026 
4027 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4028 						  const char *name,
4029 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4030 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4031 						  struct vif_params *params);
4032 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4033 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4034 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4035 				       struct net_device *dev,
4036 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4037 				       struct vif_params *params);
4038 
4039 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4040 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
4041 			   struct key_params *params);
4042 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4043 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
4044 			   void *cookie,
4045 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4046 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4047 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr);
4048 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4049 				   struct net_device *netdev,
4050 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4051 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4052 					struct net_device *netdev,
4053 					u8 key_index);
4054 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4055 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4056 					  u8 key_index);
4057 
4058 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4059 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4060 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4061 				 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
4062 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4063 
4064 
4065 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4066 			       const u8 *mac,
4067 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4068 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4069 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4070 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4071 				  const u8 *mac,
4072 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4073 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4074 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4075 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4076 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4077 
4078 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4079 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4080 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4081 			       const u8 *dst);
4082 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4083 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4084 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4085 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4086 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4087 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4088 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4089 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4090 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4091 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4092 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4093 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4094 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4095 				struct net_device *dev,
4096 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4097 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4098 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4099 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4100 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4101 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4102 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4103 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4104 
4105 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4106 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4107 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4108 
4109 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4110 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4111 
4112 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4113 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4114 
4115 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4116 					     struct net_device *dev,
4117 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4118 
4119 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4120 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4121 
4122 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4123 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4124 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4125 
4126 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4127 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4128 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4129 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4130 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4131 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4132 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4133 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4134 
4135 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4136 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4137 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4138 					 struct net_device *dev,
4139 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4140 					 u32 changed);
4141 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4142 			      u16 reason_code);
4143 
4144 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4145 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4146 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4147 
4148 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4149 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4150 
4151 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4152 
4153 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4154 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4155 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4156 				int *dbm);
4157 
4158 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4159 
4160 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4161 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4162 				void *data, int len);
4163 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4164 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4165 				 void *data, int len);
4166 #endif
4167 
4168 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4169 				    struct net_device *dev,
4170 				    const u8 *peer,
4171 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4172 
4173 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4174 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4175 
4176 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4177 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4178 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4179 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4180 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4181 
4182 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4183 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4184 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4185 				     unsigned int duration,
4186 				     u64 *cookie);
4187 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4188 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4189 					    u64 cookie);
4190 
4191 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4192 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4193 			   u64 *cookie);
4194 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4195 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4196 				       u64 cookie);
4197 
4198 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4199 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4200 
4201 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4202 				       struct net_device *dev,
4203 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4204 
4205 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4206 					     struct net_device *dev,
4207 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4208 
4209 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4210 				      struct net_device *dev,
4211 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4212 
4213 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4214 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4215 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4216 
4217 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4218 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4219 
4220 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4221 				struct net_device *dev,
4222 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4223 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4224 				   u64 reqid);
4225 
4226 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4227 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4228 
4229 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4230 			     const u8 *peer, u8 action_code,  u8 dialog_token,
4231 			     u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
4232 			     bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4233 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4234 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4235 
4236 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4237 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4238 
4239 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4240 				  struct net_device *dev,
4241 				  u16 noack_map);
4242 
4243 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4244 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4245 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4246 
4247 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4248 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4249 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4250 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4251 
4252 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4253 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4254 
4255 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4256 					 struct net_device *dev,
4257 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4258 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4259 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4260 				struct net_device *dev);
4261 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4262 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4263 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4264 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4265 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4266 				    u16 duration);
4267 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4268 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4269 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4270 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4271 
4272 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4273 				  struct net_device *dev,
4274 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4275 
4276 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4277 			       struct net_device *dev,
4278 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4279 
4280 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4281 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4282 
4283 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4284 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4285 			     u16 admitted_time);
4286 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4287 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4288 
4289 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4290 				       struct net_device *dev,
4291 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4292 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4293 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4294 					      struct net_device *dev,
4295 					      const u8 *addr);
4296 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4297 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4298 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4299 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4300 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4301 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4302 			       u64 cookie);
4303 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4304 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4305 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4306 				   u32 changes);
4307 
4308 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4309 					    struct net_device *dev,
4310 					    const bool enabled);
4311 
4312 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4313 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4314 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4315 
4316 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4317 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4318 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4319 			   const u8 *aa);
4320 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4321 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4322 
4323 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4324 				   struct net_device *dev,
4325 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4326 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4327 				   const bool noencrypt,
4328 				   u64 *cookie);
4329 
4330 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4331 				struct net_device *dev,
4332 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4333 
4334 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4335 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4336 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4337 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4338 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4339 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4340 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4341 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4342 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4343 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4344 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4345 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4346 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4347 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4348 	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4349 				struct net_device *dev,
4350 				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4351 };
4352 
4353 /*
4354  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4355  * and registration/helper functions
4356  */
4357 
4358 /**
4359  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4360  *
4361  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4362  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4363  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4364  *	wiphy at all
4365  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4366  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4367  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4368  *	reason to override the default
4369  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4370  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4371  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4372  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4373  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4374  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4375  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4376  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4377  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4378  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4379  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4380  *	firmware.
4381  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4382  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4383  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4384  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4385  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4386  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4387  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4388  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4389  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4390  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4391  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4392  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4393  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4394  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4395  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4396  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4397  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4398  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4399  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
4400  *	before connection.
4401  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4402  */
4403 enum wiphy_flags {
4404 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4405 	/* use hole at 1 */
4406 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4407 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4408 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4409 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4410 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4411 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4412 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4413 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4414 	/* use hole at 11 */
4415 	/* use hole at 12 */
4416 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4417 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4418 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4419 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4420 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4421 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4422 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4423 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4424 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4425 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4426 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4427 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP		= BIT(24),
4428 };
4429 
4430 /**
4431  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4432  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4433  * @types: interface types (bits)
4434  */
4435 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4436 	u16 max;
4437 	u16 types;
4438 };
4439 
4440 /**
4441  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4442  *
4443  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4444  * combinations it supports concurrently.
4445  *
4446  * Examples:
4447  *
4448  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4449  *
4450  *    .. code-block:: c
4451  *
4452  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4453  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4454  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4455  *	};
4456  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4457  *		.limits = limits1,
4458  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4459  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
4460  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4461  *	};
4462  *
4463  *
4464  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4465  *
4466  *    .. code-block:: c
4467  *
4468  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4469  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4470  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4471  *	};
4472  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4473  *		.limits = limits2,
4474  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4475  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
4476  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
4477  *	};
4478  *
4479  *
4480  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4481  *
4482  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4483  *
4484  *    .. code-block:: c
4485  *
4486  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4487  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4488  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4489  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4490  *	};
4491  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4492  *		.limits = limits3,
4493  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4494  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
4495  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
4496  *	};
4497  *
4498  */
4499 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4500 	/**
4501 	 * @limits:
4502 	 * limits for the given interface types
4503 	 */
4504 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4505 
4506 	/**
4507 	 * @num_different_channels:
4508 	 * can use up to this many different channels
4509 	 */
4510 	u32 num_different_channels;
4511 
4512 	/**
4513 	 * @max_interfaces:
4514 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4515 	 */
4516 	u16 max_interfaces;
4517 
4518 	/**
4519 	 * @n_limits:
4520 	 * number of limitations
4521 	 */
4522 	u8 n_limits;
4523 
4524 	/**
4525 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4526 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4527 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4528 	 */
4529 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4530 
4531 	/**
4532 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
4533 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4534 	 */
4535 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
4536 
4537 	/**
4538 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
4539 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4540 	 */
4541 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
4542 
4543 	/**
4544 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4545 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4546 	 *
4547 	 * = 0
4548 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4549 	 * > 0
4550 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4551 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4552 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4553 	 */
4554 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4555 };
4556 
4557 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4558 	u16 tx, rx;
4559 };
4560 
4561 /**
4562  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4563  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4564  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4565  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4566  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4567  *	packet should be preserved in that case
4568  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4569  *	(see nl80211.h)
4570  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4571  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4572  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4573  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4574  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4575  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4576  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4577  */
4578 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4579 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
4580 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
4581 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
4582 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
4583 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
4584 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
4585 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
4586 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
4587 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
4588 };
4589 
4590 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4591 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4592 	u32 data_payload_max;
4593 	u32 data_interval_max;
4594 	u32 wake_payload_max;
4595 	bool seq;
4596 };
4597 
4598 /**
4599  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4600  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4601  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4602  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4603  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4604  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4605  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4606  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4607  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4608  *	scheduled scans.
4609  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4610  *	details.
4611  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4612  */
4613 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
4614 	u32 flags;
4615 	int n_patterns;
4616 	int pattern_max_len;
4617 	int pattern_min_len;
4618 	int max_pkt_offset;
4619 	int max_nd_match_sets;
4620 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
4621 };
4622 
4623 /**
4624  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
4625  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
4626  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
4627  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
4628  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4629  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4630  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4631  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4632  */
4633 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
4634 	int n_rules;
4635 	int max_delay;
4636 	int n_patterns;
4637 	int pattern_max_len;
4638 	int pattern_min_len;
4639 	int max_pkt_offset;
4640 };
4641 
4642 /**
4643  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
4644  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
4645  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
4646  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
4647  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
4648  */
4649 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
4650 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
4651 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
4652 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
4653 };
4654 
4655 /**
4656  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
4657  *
4658  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
4659  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
4660  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
4661  *
4662  */
4663 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
4664 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
4665 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
4666 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
4667 };
4668 
4669 /**
4670  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
4671  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
4672  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
4673  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
4674  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
4675  */
4676 
4677 struct sta_opmode_info {
4678 	u32 changed;
4679 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
4680 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
4681 	u8 rx_nss;
4682 };
4683 
4684 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
4685 
4686 /**
4687  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
4688  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
4689  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
4690  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
4691  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
4692  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
4693  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
4694  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
4695  *	dumpit calls.
4696  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
4697  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
4698  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
4699  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
4700  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
4701  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
4702  * are used with dump requests.
4703  */
4704 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
4705 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
4706 	u32 flags;
4707 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4708 		    const void *data, int data_len);
4709 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4710 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
4711 		      unsigned long *storage);
4712 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
4713 	unsigned int maxattr;
4714 };
4715 
4716 /**
4717  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
4718  * @iftype: interface type
4719  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4720  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
4721  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
4722  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
4723  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
4724  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4725  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4726  */
4727 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
4728 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
4729 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
4730 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
4731 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4732 };
4733 
4734 /**
4735  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
4736  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
4737  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
4738  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
4739  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
4740  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
4741  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
4742  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
4743  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
4744  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
4745  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
4746  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
4747  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
4748  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
4749  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
4750  *	not limited)
4751  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4752  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4753  */
4754 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
4755 	unsigned int max_peers;
4756 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
4757 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
4758 
4759 	struct {
4760 		u32 preambles;
4761 		u32 bandwidths;
4762 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
4763 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
4764 		u8 supported:1,
4765 		   asap:1,
4766 		   non_asap:1,
4767 		   request_lci:1,
4768 		   request_civicloc:1,
4769 		   trigger_based:1,
4770 		   non_trigger_based:1;
4771 	} ftm;
4772 };
4773 
4774 /**
4775  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
4776  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
4777  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
4778  *
4779  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
4780  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
4781  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4782  */
4783 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
4784 	u16 iftypes_mask;
4785 	const u32 *akm_suites;
4786 	int n_akm_suites;
4787 };
4788 
4789 /**
4790  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
4791  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
4792  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
4793  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
4794  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
4795  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
4796  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
4797  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
4798  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
4799  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
4800  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
4801  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
4802  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
4803  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
4804  *	iftype_akm_suites.
4805  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4806  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
4807  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
4808  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
4809  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
4810  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
4811  *	suites are specified separately.
4812  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
4813  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
4814  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
4815  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
4816  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
4817  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
4818  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
4819  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
4820  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
4821  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
4822  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
4823  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
4824  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
4825  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
4826  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
4827  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
4828  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
4829  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
4830  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
4831  *	unregister hardware
4832  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
4833  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
4834  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
4835  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
4836  *	(see below).
4837  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
4838  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
4839  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
4840  *	must be set by driver
4841  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
4842  *	list single interface types.
4843  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
4844  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
4845  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
4846  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
4847  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
4848  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
4849  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
4850  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
4851  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
4852  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
4853  *	this variable determines its size
4854  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
4855  *	any given scan
4856  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
4857  *	the device can run concurrently.
4858  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
4859  *	for in any given scheduled scan
4860  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
4861  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
4862  *	supported.
4863  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
4864  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
4865  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
4866  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
4867  *	scans
4868  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
4869  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
4870  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
4871  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
4872  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
4873  *	scan plan supported by the device.
4874  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
4875  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
4876  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
4877  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
4878  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
4879  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
4880  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
4881  *
4882  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
4883  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
4884  *	type
4885  *
4886  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4887  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4888  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
4889  *
4890  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4891  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4892  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
4893  *
4894  * @probe_resp_offload:
4895  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
4896  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
4897  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
4898  *
4899  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
4900  *	may request, if implemented.
4901  *
4902  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
4903  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
4904  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
4905  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
4906  *
4907  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
4908  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
4909  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4910  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
4911  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4912  *
4913  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
4914  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
4915  *
4916  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
4917  *	supports for ACL.
4918  *
4919  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4920  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
4921  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
4922  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
4923  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
4924  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
4925  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
4926  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4927  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4928  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
4929  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
4930  *	capabilities are specified separately.
4931  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
4932  *
4933  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
4934  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
4935  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
4936  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
4937  *
4938  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
4939  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
4940  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
4941  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
4942  *
4943  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
4944  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
4945  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
4946  *	infinite.
4947  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
4948  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
4949  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
4950  *
4951  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
4952  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
4953  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
4954  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
4955  *
4956  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
4957  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
4958  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
4959  *
4960  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
4961  *	wake_tx_queue
4962  *
4963  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
4964  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
4965  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
4966  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
4967  *
4968  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
4969  *
4970  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
4971  *	device has
4972  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4973  *	supported by the driver for each vif
4974  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4975  *	supported by the driver for each peer
4976  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
4977  *	long/short retry configuration
4978  *
4979  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
4980  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
4981  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
4982  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
4983  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
4984  */
4985 struct wiphy {
4986 	struct mutex mtx;
4987 
4988 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
4989 
4990 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
4991 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
4992 
4993 	struct mac_address *addresses;
4994 
4995 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
4996 
4997 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
4998 	int n_iface_combinations;
4999 	u16 software_iftypes;
5000 
5001 	u16 n_addresses;
5002 
5003 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5004 	u16 interface_modes;
5005 
5006 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5007 
5008 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5009 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5010 
5011 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5012 
5013 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5014 
5015 	int bss_priv_size;
5016 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5017 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5018 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5019 	u8 max_match_sets;
5020 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5021 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5022 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5023 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5024 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5025 
5026 	int n_cipher_suites;
5027 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5028 
5029 	int n_akm_suites;
5030 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5031 
5032 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5033 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5034 
5035 	u8 retry_short;
5036 	u8 retry_long;
5037 	u32 frag_threshold;
5038 	u32 rts_threshold;
5039 	u8 coverage_class;
5040 
5041 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5042 	u32 hw_version;
5043 
5044 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5045 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5046 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5047 #endif
5048 
5049 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5050 
5051 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5052 
5053 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5054 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5055 
5056 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5057 
5058 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5059 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5060 
5061 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5062 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5063 
5064 	const void *privid;
5065 
5066 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5067 
5068 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5069 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5070 
5071 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5072 
5073 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5074 
5075 	struct device dev;
5076 
5077 	bool registered;
5078 
5079 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5080 
5081 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5082 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5083 
5084 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5085 
5086 	possible_net_t _net;
5087 
5088 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5089 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5090 #endif
5091 
5092 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5093 
5094 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5095 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5096 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5097 
5098 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5099 
5100 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5101 
5102 	u32 bss_select_support;
5103 
5104 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5105 
5106 	u32 txq_limit;
5107 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5108 	u32 txq_quantum;
5109 
5110 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5111 
5112 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5113 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5114 
5115 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5116 
5117 	struct {
5118 		u64 peer, vif;
5119 		u8 max_retry;
5120 	} tid_config_support;
5121 
5122 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5123 
5124 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5125 
5126 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5127 
5128 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5129 };
5130 
5131 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5132 {
5133 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5134 }
5135 
5136 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5137 {
5138 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5139 }
5140 
5141 /**
5142  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5143  *
5144  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5145  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5146  */
5147 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5148 {
5149 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5150 	return &wiphy->priv;
5151 }
5152 
5153 /**
5154  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5155  *
5156  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5157  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5158  */
5159 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5160 {
5161 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5162 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5163 }
5164 
5165 /**
5166  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5167  *
5168  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5169  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5170  */
5171 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5172 {
5173 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5174 }
5175 
5176 /**
5177  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5178  *
5179  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5180  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5181  */
5182 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5183 {
5184 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5185 }
5186 
5187 /**
5188  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5189  *
5190  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5191  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5192  */
5193 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5194 {
5195 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5196 }
5197 
5198 /**
5199  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5200  *
5201  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5202  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5203  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5204  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5205  *
5206  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5207  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5208  *
5209  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5210  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5211  */
5212 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5213 			   const char *requested_name);
5214 
5215 /**
5216  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5217  *
5218  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5219  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5220  *
5221  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5222  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5223  *
5224  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5225  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5226  */
5227 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5228 				      int sizeof_priv)
5229 {
5230 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5231 }
5232 
5233 /**
5234  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5235  *
5236  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5237  *
5238  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5239  */
5240 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5241 
5242 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5243 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5244 
5245 /**
5246  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5247  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5248  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5249  *
5250  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5251  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5252  */
5253 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5254         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5255 
5256 /**
5257  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5258  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5259  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5260  *
5261  * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5262  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5263  */
5264 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5265         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5266 
5267 /**
5268  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5269  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5270  */
5271 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5272 
5273 /**
5274  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5275  *
5276  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5277  *
5278  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5279  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5280  * request that is being handled.
5281  */
5282 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5283 
5284 /**
5285  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5286  *
5287  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5288  */
5289 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5290 
5291 /* internal structs */
5292 struct cfg80211_conn;
5293 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5294 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5295 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5296 
5297 /**
5298  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5299  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5300  *
5301  * This is mostly exposed so it can be done around registering and
5302  * unregistering netdevs that aren't created through cfg80211 calls,
5303  * since that requires locking in cfg80211 when the notifiers is
5304  * called, but that cannot differentiate which way it's called.
5305  *
5306  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5307  */
5308 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5309 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5310 {
5311 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5312 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5313 }
5314 
5315 /**
5316  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5317  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5318  */
5319 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5320 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5321 {
5322 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5323 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5324 }
5325 
5326 /**
5327  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5328  *
5329  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5330  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5331  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5332  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5333  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
5334  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
5335  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
5336  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
5337  *
5338  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
5339  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
5340  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
5341  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
5342  *
5343  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
5344  * @iftype: interface type
5345  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
5346  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
5347  *	for the notifier
5348  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
5349  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
5350  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
5351  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
5352  * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5353  * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track
5354  *	the user-set channel definition.
5355  * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to
5356  *	track the channel to be used for AP later
5357  * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5358  * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5359  * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5360  * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5361  * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5362  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
5363  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
5364  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
5365  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
5366  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
5367  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
5368  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
5369  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
5370  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
5371  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
5372  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
5373  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
5374  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
5375  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
5376  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
5377  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
5378  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
5379  * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list
5380  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
5381  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
5382  * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
5383  *	and some API functions require it held
5384  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
5385  *	beacons, 0 when not valid
5386  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
5387  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
5388  *	the P2P Device.
5389  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
5390  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
5391  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
5392  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
5393  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
5394  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
5395  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
5396  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
5397  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
5398  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
5399  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
5400  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
5401  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
5402  * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID
5403  * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel
5404  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
5405  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
5406  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
5407  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
5408  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
5409  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
5410  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
5411  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
5412  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
5413  *	unprotected beacon report
5414  */
5415 struct wireless_dev {
5416 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5417 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5418 
5419 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
5420 	struct list_head list;
5421 	struct net_device *netdev;
5422 
5423 	u32 identifier;
5424 
5425 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
5426 	spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock;
5427 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
5428 
5429 	struct mutex mtx;
5430 
5431 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
5432 
5433 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
5434 
5435 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
5436 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5437 	u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len;
5438 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
5439 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
5440 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
5441 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
5442 
5443 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
5444 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5445 
5446 	struct list_head event_list;
5447 	spinlock_t event_lock;
5448 
5449 	struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */
5450 	struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
5451 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
5452 
5453 	bool ibss_fixed;
5454 	bool ibss_dfs_possible;
5455 
5456 	bool ps;
5457 	int ps_timeout;
5458 
5459 	int beacon_interval;
5460 
5461 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
5462 
5463 	u32 owner_nlportid;
5464 	bool nl_owner_dead;
5465 
5466 	bool cac_started;
5467 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
5468 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
5469 
5470 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5471 	/* wext data */
5472 	struct {
5473 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
5474 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
5475 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
5476 		const u8 *ie;
5477 		size_t ie_len;
5478 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5479 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5480 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5481 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
5482 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
5483 	} wext;
5484 #endif
5485 
5486 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
5487 
5488 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
5489 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
5490 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
5491 
5492 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
5493 };
5494 
5495 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5496 {
5497 	if (wdev->netdev)
5498 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
5499 	return wdev->address;
5500 }
5501 
5502 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5503 {
5504 	if (wdev->netdev)
5505 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
5506 	return wdev->is_running;
5507 }
5508 
5509 /**
5510  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
5511  *
5512  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
5513  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
5514  */
5515 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5516 {
5517 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
5518 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
5519 }
5520 
5521 /**
5522  * DOC: Utility functions
5523  *
5524  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
5525  */
5526 
5527 /**
5528  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
5529  *
5530  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
5531  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
5532  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
5533  */
5534 static inline bool
5535 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
5536 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
5537 {
5538 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
5539 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
5540 }
5541 
5542 /**
5543  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
5544  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
5545  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
5546  */
5547 static inline u32
5548 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5549 {
5550 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
5551 }
5552 
5553 /**
5554  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
5555  *
5556  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
5557  * @chan: channel
5558  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
5559  */
5560 enum nl80211_chan_width
5561 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
5562 
5563 /**
5564  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
5565  * @chan: channel number
5566  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5567  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5568  */
5569 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
5570 
5571 /**
5572  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
5573  * @chan: channel number
5574  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5575  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5576  */
5577 static inline int
5578 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
5579 {
5580 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
5581 }
5582 
5583 /**
5584  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5585  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
5586  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5587  */
5588 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
5589 
5590 /**
5591  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5592  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
5593  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5594  */
5595 static inline int
5596 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
5597 {
5598 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5599 }
5600 
5601 /**
5602  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
5603  * frequency
5604  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5605  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
5606  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5607  */
5608 struct ieee80211_channel *
5609 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
5610 
5611 /**
5612  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
5613  *
5614  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5615  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
5616  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5617  */
5618 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
5619 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
5620 {
5621 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5622 }
5623 
5624 /**
5625  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
5626  * @chan: control channel to check
5627  *
5628  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
5629  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
5630  */
5631 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5632 {
5633 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
5634 		return false;
5635 
5636 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
5637 }
5638 
5639 /**
5640  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
5641  *
5642  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5643  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
5644  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
5645  *
5646  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
5647  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
5648  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
5649  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
5650  */
5651 const struct ieee80211_rate *
5652 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5653 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
5654 
5655 /**
5656  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
5657  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5658  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
5659  *
5660  * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
5661  * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
5662  */
5663 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5664 			      enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
5665 
5666 /*
5667  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
5668  *
5669  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
5670  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
5671  */
5672 
5673 struct radiotap_align_size {
5674 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
5675 };
5676 
5677 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
5678 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
5679 	int n_bits;
5680 	uint32_t oui;
5681 	uint8_t subns;
5682 };
5683 
5684 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
5685 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
5686 	int n_ns;
5687 };
5688 
5689 /**
5690  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
5691  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
5692  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
5693  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
5694  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
5695  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
5696  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
5697  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
5698  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
5699  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
5700  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
5701  *	radiotap namespace or not
5702  *
5703  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
5704  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
5705  * @_arg_index: next argument index
5706  * @_arg: next argument pointer
5707  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
5708  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
5709  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
5710  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
5711  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
5712  *	next bitmap word
5713  *
5714  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
5715  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
5716  */
5717 
5718 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
5719 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
5720 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
5721 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
5722 
5723 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
5724 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
5725 
5726 	unsigned char *this_arg;
5727 	int this_arg_index;
5728 	int this_arg_size;
5729 
5730 	int is_radiotap_ns;
5731 
5732 	int _max_length;
5733 	int _arg_index;
5734 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
5735 	int _reset_on_ext;
5736 };
5737 
5738 int
5739 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
5740 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
5741 				 int max_length,
5742 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
5743 
5744 int
5745 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
5746 
5747 
5748 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
5749 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
5750 
5751 /**
5752  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
5753  *
5754  * @skb: the frame
5755  *
5756  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
5757  * returns the 802.11 header length.
5758  *
5759  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
5760  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
5761  * 802.11 header.
5762  */
5763 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
5764 
5765 /**
5766  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
5767  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
5768  * Return: The header length in bytes.
5769  */
5770 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
5771 
5772 /**
5773  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
5774  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
5775  *	(first byte) will be accessed
5776  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
5777  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
5778  */
5779 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
5780 
5781 /**
5782  * DOC: Data path helpers
5783  *
5784  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
5785  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
5786  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
5787  */
5788 
5789 /**
5790  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5791  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5792  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
5793  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
5794  * @addr: the device MAC address
5795  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5796  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
5797  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5798  */
5799 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
5800 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5801 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
5802 
5803 /**
5804  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5805  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5806  * @addr: the device MAC address
5807  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5808  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5809  */
5810 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
5811 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
5812 {
5813 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
5814 }
5815 
5816 /**
5817  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
5818  *
5819  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
5820  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
5821  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
5822  *
5823  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
5824  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
5825  *	initialized by the caller.
5826  * @addr: The device MAC address.
5827  * @iftype: The device interface type.
5828  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
5829  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5830  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5831  */
5832 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
5833 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5834 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
5835 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
5836 
5837 /**
5838  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
5839  * @skb: the data frame
5840  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
5841  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
5842  */
5843 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
5844 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
5845 
5846 /**
5847  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
5848  *
5849  * @eid: element ID
5850  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5851  * @len: length of data
5852  * @match: byte array to match
5853  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5854  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
5855  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
5856  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
5857  *	the data portion instead.
5858  *
5859  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5860  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5861  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5862  * requested element struct.
5863  *
5864  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5865  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5866  * byte array to match.
5867  */
5868 const struct element *
5869 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5870 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5871 			 unsigned int match_offset);
5872 
5873 /**
5874  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
5875  *
5876  * @eid: element ID
5877  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5878  * @len: length of data
5879  * @match: byte array to match
5880  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5881  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
5882  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
5883  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
5884  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
5885  *	the second byte is the IE length.
5886  *
5887  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5888  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5889  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
5890  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5891  * element ID.
5892  *
5893  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5894  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5895  * byte array to match.
5896  */
5897 static inline const u8 *
5898 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5899 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5900 		       unsigned int match_offset)
5901 {
5902 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
5903 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
5904 	 */
5905 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
5906 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
5907 		return NULL;
5908 
5909 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
5910 						match, match_len,
5911 						match_offset ?
5912 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
5913 }
5914 
5915 /**
5916  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
5917  *
5918  * @eid: element ID
5919  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5920  * @len: length of data
5921  *
5922  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5923  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5924  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5925  * requested element struct.
5926  *
5927  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5928  * having to fit into the given data.
5929  */
5930 static inline const struct element *
5931 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5932 {
5933 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5934 }
5935 
5936 /**
5937  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
5938  *
5939  * @eid: element ID
5940  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5941  * @len: length of data
5942  *
5943  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5944  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5945  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5946  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5947  *
5948  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5949  * having to fit into the given data.
5950  */
5951 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5952 {
5953 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5954 }
5955 
5956 /**
5957  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
5958  *
5959  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5960  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5961  * @len: length of data
5962  *
5963  * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
5964  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5965  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5966  * requested element struct.
5967  *
5968  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5969  * having to fit into the given data.
5970  */
5971 static inline const struct element *
5972 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5973 {
5974 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5975 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
5976 }
5977 
5978 /**
5979  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
5980  *
5981  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5982  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5983  * @len: length of data
5984  *
5985  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
5986  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5987  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5988  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5989  *
5990  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5991  * having to fit into the given data.
5992  */
5993 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5994 {
5995 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5996 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
5997 }
5998 
5999 /**
6000  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6001  *
6002  * @oui: vendor OUI
6003  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6004  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6005  * @len: length of data
6006  *
6007  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6008  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6009  * return the element structure for the requested element.
6010  *
6011  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6012  * the given data.
6013  */
6014 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6015 						const u8 *ies,
6016 						unsigned int len);
6017 
6018 /**
6019  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6020  *
6021  * @oui: vendor OUI
6022  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6023  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6024  * @len: length of data
6025  *
6026  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6027  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6028  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6029  * element ID.
6030  *
6031  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6032  * the given data.
6033  */
6034 static inline const u8 *
6035 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6036 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6037 {
6038 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6039 }
6040 
6041 /**
6042  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6043  *
6044  * @dev: network device
6045  * @addr: STA MAC address
6046  *
6047  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6048  * devices upon STA association.
6049  */
6050 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6051 
6052 /**
6053  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6054  *
6055  * TODO
6056  */
6057 
6058 /**
6059  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6060  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6061  *	conflicts)
6062  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6063  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6064  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6065  *	alpha2.
6066  *
6067  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6068  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6069  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6070  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6071  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6072  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6073  *
6074  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6075  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6076  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6077  *
6078  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6079  * an -ENOMEM.
6080  *
6081  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6082  */
6083 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6084 
6085 /**
6086  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6087  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6088  * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
6089  *
6090  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6091  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6092  * information.
6093  *
6094  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6095  */
6096 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6097 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6098 
6099 /**
6100  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
6101  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6102  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6103  *
6104  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
6105  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
6106  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
6107  *
6108  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6109  */
6110 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6111 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6112 
6113 /**
6114  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
6115  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6116  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
6117  *
6118  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
6119  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
6120  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
6121  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
6122  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
6123  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
6124  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
6125  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
6126  * that called this helper.
6127  */
6128 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6129 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
6130 
6131 /**
6132  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
6133  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
6134  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
6135  *
6136  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
6137  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
6138  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
6139  * and processed already.
6140  *
6141  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
6142  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
6143  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
6144  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
6145  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
6146  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
6147  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
6148  */
6149 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6150 					       u32 center_freq);
6151 
6152 /**
6153  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
6154  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
6155  *
6156  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
6157  * proper string representation.
6158  */
6159 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
6160 
6161 /**
6162  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
6163  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
6164  *
6165  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
6166  */
6167 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6168 
6169 /**
6170  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
6171  *
6172  */
6173 
6174 /**
6175  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
6176  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
6177  *
6178  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
6179  * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
6180  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
6181  *
6182  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
6183  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
6184  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
6185  *
6186  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6187  * an -ENODATA.
6188  *
6189  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
6190  */
6191 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
6192 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
6193 
6194 /*
6195  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
6196  * functions and BSS handling helpers
6197  */
6198 
6199 /**
6200  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
6201  *
6202  * @request: the corresponding scan request
6203  * @info: information about the completed scan
6204  */
6205 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
6206 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6207 
6208 /**
6209  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
6210  *
6211  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
6212  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6213  */
6214 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6215 
6216 /**
6217  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6218  *
6219  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6220  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6221  *
6222  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6223  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6224  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6225  */
6226 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6227 
6228 /**
6229  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6230  *
6231  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6232  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6233  *
6234  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6235  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6236  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6237  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
6238  */
6239 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6240 
6241 /**
6242  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
6243  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6244  * @data: the BSS metadata
6245  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
6246  * @len: length of the management frame
6247  * @gfp: context flags
6248  *
6249  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6250  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6251  *
6252  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6253  * Or %NULL on error.
6254  */
6255 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6256 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6257 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6258 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6259 			       gfp_t gfp);
6260 
6261 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6262 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6263 				struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6264 				enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6265 				struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6266 				s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6267 {
6268 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6269 		.chan = rx_channel,
6270 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6271 		.signal = signal,
6272 	};
6273 
6274 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6275 }
6276 
6277 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6278 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6279 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6280 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6281 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6282 {
6283 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6284 		.chan = rx_channel,
6285 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6286 		.signal = signal,
6287 	};
6288 
6289 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6290 }
6291 
6292 /**
6293  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
6294  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
6295  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
6296  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
6297  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
6298  */
6299 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
6300 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
6301 {
6302 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
6303 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
6304 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
6305 
6306 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
6307 
6308 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
6309 
6310 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
6311 }
6312 
6313 /**
6314  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
6315  * @element: element to check
6316  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
6317  */
6318 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
6319 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
6320 
6321 /**
6322  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
6323  * @ie: ies
6324  * @ielen: length of IEs
6325  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
6326  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
6327  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
6328  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
6329  */
6330 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6331 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
6332 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
6333 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
6334 
6335 /**
6336  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
6337  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
6338  *	from a beacon or probe response
6339  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
6340  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
6341  */
6342 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
6343 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
6344 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
6345 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
6346 };
6347 
6348 /**
6349  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
6350  *
6351  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6352  * @data: the BSS metadata
6353  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
6354  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
6355  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
6356  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
6357  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
6358  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
6359  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
6360  * @gfp: context flags
6361  *
6362  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6363  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6364  *
6365  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6366  * Or %NULL on error.
6367  */
6368 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6369 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6370 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6371 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6372 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6373 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6374 			 gfp_t gfp);
6375 
6376 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6377 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6378 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6379 			  enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6380 			  enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6381 			  const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6382 			  u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6383 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6384 {
6385 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6386 		.chan = rx_channel,
6387 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6388 		.signal = signal,
6389 	};
6390 
6391 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6392 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6393 					gfp);
6394 }
6395 
6396 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6397 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6398 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6399 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6400 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6401 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6402 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6403 {
6404 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6405 		.chan = rx_channel,
6406 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6407 		.signal = signal,
6408 	};
6409 
6410 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6411 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6412 					gfp);
6413 }
6414 
6415 /**
6416  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
6417  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6418  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
6419  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
6420  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
6421  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
6422  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
6423  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
6424  */
6425 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6426 				      struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6427 				      const u8 *bssid,
6428 				      const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
6429 				      enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
6430 				      enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
6431 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
6432 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6433 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6434 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
6435 {
6436 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
6437 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
6438 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
6439 }
6440 
6441 /**
6442  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
6443  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6444  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
6445  *
6446  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6447  */
6448 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6449 
6450 /**
6451  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
6452  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6453  * @bss: the BSS struct
6454  *
6455  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6456  */
6457 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6458 
6459 /**
6460  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
6461  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6462  * @bss: the bss to remove
6463  *
6464  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
6465  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
6466  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
6467  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
6468  */
6469 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6470 
6471 /**
6472  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
6473  *
6474  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
6475  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
6476  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
6477  *
6478  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6479  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
6480  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
6481  * @iter: the iterator function to call
6482  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
6483  */
6484 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6485 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6486 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6487 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6488 				    void *data),
6489 		       void *iter_data);
6490 
6491 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
6492 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
6493 {
6494 	switch (chandef->width) {
6495 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
6496 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
6497 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
6498 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
6499 	default:
6500 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6501 	}
6502 }
6503 
6504 /**
6505  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
6506  * @dev: network device
6507  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
6508  * @len: length of the frame data
6509  *
6510  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
6511  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
6512  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
6513  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6514  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6515  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6516  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
6517  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
6518  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
6519  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
6520  *
6521  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6522  */
6523 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6524 
6525 /**
6526  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
6527  * @dev: network device
6528  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
6529  *
6530  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
6531  * mutex.
6532  */
6533 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6534 
6535 /**
6536  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
6537  * @dev: network device
6538  * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
6539  *	moves to cfg80211 in this call
6540  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
6541  * @len: length of the frame data
6542  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
6543  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
6544  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
6545  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
6546  *
6547  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6548  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6549  *
6550  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6551  */
6552 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
6553 			    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6554 			    const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6555 			    int uapsd_queues,
6556 			    const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len);
6557 
6558 /**
6559  * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association
6560  * @dev: network device
6561  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out.
6562  *
6563  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6564  */
6565 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6566 
6567 /**
6568  * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt
6569  * @dev: network device
6570  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned.
6571  *
6572  * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX,
6573  * an association attempt was abandoned.
6574  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6575  */
6576 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6577 
6578 /**
6579  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
6580  * @dev: network device
6581  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
6582  * @len: length of the frame data
6583  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
6584  *
6585  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
6586  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
6587  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
6588  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
6589  */
6590 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6591 			   bool reconnect);
6592 
6593 /**
6594  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
6595  * @dev: network device
6596  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
6597  * @len: length of the frame data
6598  *
6599  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
6600  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
6601  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
6602  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
6603  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
6604  *
6605  * This function may sleep.
6606  */
6607 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
6608 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6609 
6610 /**
6611  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
6612  * @dev: network device
6613  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
6614  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
6615  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
6616  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
6617  * @gfp: allocation flags
6618  *
6619  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
6620  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
6621  * primitive.
6622  */
6623 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
6624 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
6625 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
6626 
6627 /**
6628  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
6629  *
6630  * @dev: network device
6631  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
6632  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
6633  * @gfp: allocation flags
6634  *
6635  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
6636  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
6637  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
6638  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
6639  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
6640  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
6641  */
6642 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6643 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
6644 
6645 /**
6646  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
6647  * 					candidate
6648  *
6649  * @dev: network device
6650  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
6651  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
6652  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
6653  * @gfp: allocation flags
6654  *
6655  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
6656  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
6657  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
6658  */
6659 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
6660 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
6661 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
6662 
6663 /**
6664  * DOC: RFkill integration
6665  *
6666  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
6667  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
6668  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
6669  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
6670  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
6671  *
6672  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
6673  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
6674  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
6675  */
6676 
6677 /**
6678  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
6679  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6680  * @blocked: block status
6681  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
6682  */
6683 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
6684 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
6685 
6686 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
6687 {
6688 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
6689 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
6690 }
6691 
6692 /**
6693  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
6694  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6695  */
6696 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6697 
6698 /**
6699  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
6700  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6701  */
6702 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6703 {
6704 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
6705 }
6706 
6707 /**
6708  * DOC: Vendor commands
6709  *
6710  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
6711  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
6712  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
6713  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
6714  * the configuration mechanism.
6715  *
6716  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
6717  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
6718  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
6719  *
6720  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
6721  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
6722  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
6723  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
6724  * managers etc. need.
6725  */
6726 
6727 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6728 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6729 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6730 					   int approxlen);
6731 
6732 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6733 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6734 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6735 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6736 					   unsigned int portid,
6737 					   int vendor_event_idx,
6738 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
6739 
6740 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
6741 
6742 /**
6743  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
6744  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6745  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6746  *	be put into the skb
6747  *
6748  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6749  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6750  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
6751  *
6752  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
6753  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6754  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6755  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6756  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6757  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
6758  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
6759  *
6760  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
6761  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
6762  *
6763  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6764  */
6765 static inline struct sk_buff *
6766 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6767 {
6768 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6769 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
6770 }
6771 
6772 /**
6773  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
6774  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6775  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
6776  *
6777  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6778  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
6779  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
6780  * skb regardless of the return value.
6781  *
6782  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6783  */
6784 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
6785 
6786 /**
6787  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
6788  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6789  *
6790  * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
6791  * Valid to call only there.
6792  */
6793 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6794 
6795 /**
6796  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
6797  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6798  * @wdev: the wireless device
6799  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6800  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6801  *	be put into the skb
6802  * @gfp: allocation flags
6803  *
6804  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6805  * vendor-specific multicast group.
6806  *
6807  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6808  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6809  * attribute.
6810  *
6811  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6812  * skb to send the event.
6813  *
6814  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6815  */
6816 static inline struct sk_buff *
6817 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6818 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6819 {
6820 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6821 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6822 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6823 }
6824 
6825 /**
6826  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
6827  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6828  * @wdev: the wireless device
6829  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6830  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
6831  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6832  *	be put into the skb
6833  * @gfp: allocation flags
6834  *
6835  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
6836  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
6837  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
6838  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
6839  *
6840  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6841  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6842  * attribute.
6843  *
6844  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6845  * skb to send the event.
6846  *
6847  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6848  */
6849 static inline struct sk_buff *
6850 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6851 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6852 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
6853 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6854 {
6855 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6856 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6857 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6858 }
6859 
6860 /**
6861  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
6862  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
6863  * @gfp: allocation flags
6864  *
6865  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6866  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
6867  */
6868 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6869 {
6870 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6871 }
6872 
6873 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
6874 /**
6875  * DOC: Test mode
6876  *
6877  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
6878  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
6879  * factory programming.
6880  *
6881  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
6882  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
6883  */
6884 
6885 /**
6886  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
6887  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6888  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6889  *	be put into the skb
6890  *
6891  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6892  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6893  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
6894  *
6895  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
6896  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6897  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6898  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6899  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6900  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
6901  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
6902  *
6903  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
6904  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
6905  *
6906  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6907  */
6908 static inline struct sk_buff *
6909 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6910 {
6911 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6912 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
6913 }
6914 
6915 /**
6916  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
6917  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6918  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
6919  *
6920  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6921  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
6922  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
6923  * regardless of the return value.
6924  *
6925  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6926  */
6927 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
6928 {
6929 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
6930 }
6931 
6932 /**
6933  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
6934  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6935  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6936  *	be put into the skb
6937  * @gfp: allocation flags
6938  *
6939  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6940  * testmode multicast group.
6941  *
6942  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
6943  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
6944  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
6945  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
6946  * in any other way.
6947  *
6948  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
6949  * skb to send the event.
6950  *
6951  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6952  */
6953 static inline struct sk_buff *
6954 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
6955 {
6956 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6957 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
6958 					  approxlen, gfp);
6959 }
6960 
6961 /**
6962  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
6963  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6964  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
6965  * @gfp: allocation flags
6966  *
6967  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6968  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
6969  * consumes it.
6970  */
6971 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6972 {
6973 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6974 }
6975 
6976 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
6977 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
6978 #else
6979 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
6980 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
6981 #endif
6982 
6983 /**
6984  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
6985  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
6986  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
6987  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
6988  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
6989  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
6990  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
6991  *	status for a FILS connection.
6992  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6993  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
6994  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
6995  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6996  */
6997 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
6998 	const u8 *kek;
6999 	size_t kek_len;
7000 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
7001 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
7002 	const u8 *pmk;
7003 	size_t pmk_len;
7004 	const u8 *pmkid;
7005 };
7006 
7007 /**
7008  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
7009  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7010  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7011  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7012  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7013  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7014  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7015  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7016  *	case.
7017  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL)
7018  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7019  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7020  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7021  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7022  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7023  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7024  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
7025  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7026  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7027  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7028  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7029  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7030  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7031  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7032  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7033  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7034  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7035  */
7036 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7037 	int status;
7038 	const u8 *bssid;
7039 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7040 	const u8 *req_ie;
7041 	size_t req_ie_len;
7042 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7043 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7044 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7045 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
7046 };
7047 
7048 /**
7049  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7050  *
7051  * @dev: network device
7052  * @params: connection response parameters
7053  * @gfp: allocation flags
7054  *
7055  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7056  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7057  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
7058  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
7059  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
7060  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7061  */
7062 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
7063 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
7064 			   gfp_t gfp);
7065 
7066 /**
7067  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7068  *
7069  * @dev: network device
7070  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7071  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7072  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7073  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7074  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7075  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7076  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7077  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7078  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7079  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7080  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7081  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7082  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7083  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7084  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7085  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7086  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7087  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7088  *	case.
7089  * @gfp: allocation flags
7090  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7091  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7092  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7093  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7094  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7095  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7096  *
7097  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7098  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7099  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
7100  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
7101  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7102  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7103  */
7104 static inline void
7105 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7106 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
7107 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
7108 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
7109 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7110 {
7111 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
7112 
7113 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
7114 	params.status = status;
7115 	params.bssid = bssid;
7116 	params.bss = bss;
7117 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
7118 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
7119 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
7120 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
7121 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
7122 
7123 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
7124 }
7125 
7126 /**
7127  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7128  *
7129  * @dev: network device
7130  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7131  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7132  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7133  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7134  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7135  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7136  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7137  *	the real status code for failures.
7138  * @gfp: allocation flags
7139  *
7140  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7141  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7142  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
7143  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7144  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7145  */
7146 static inline void
7147 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7148 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
7149 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
7150 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
7151 {
7152 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
7153 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
7154 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
7155 }
7156 
7157 /**
7158  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
7159  *
7160  * @dev: network device
7161  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7162  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7163  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7164  * @gfp: allocation flags
7165  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
7166  *
7167  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
7168  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
7169  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
7170  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
7171  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
7172  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7173  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7174  */
7175 static inline void
7176 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7177 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
7178 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7179 {
7180 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
7181 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
7182 }
7183 
7184 /**
7185  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
7186  *
7187  * @channel: the channel of the new AP
7188  * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set)
7189  * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set)
7190  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7191  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7192  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7193  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7194  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
7195  */
7196 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
7197 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
7198 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7199 	const u8 *bssid;
7200 	const u8 *req_ie;
7201 	size_t req_ie_len;
7202 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7203 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7204 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7205 };
7206 
7207 /**
7208  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
7209  *
7210  * @dev: network device
7211  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
7212  * @gfp: allocation flags
7213  *
7214  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
7215  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
7216  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
7217  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
7218  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
7219  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
7220  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
7221  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
7222  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
7223  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
7224  */
7225 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
7226 		     gfp_t gfp);
7227 
7228 /**
7229  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
7230  *
7231  * @dev: network device
7232  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7233  * @gfp: allocation flags
7234  *
7235  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
7236  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
7237  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
7238  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
7239  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
7240  * indicate the 802.11 association.
7241  */
7242 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7243 			      gfp_t gfp);
7244 
7245 /**
7246  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
7247  *
7248  * @dev: network device
7249  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
7250  * @ie_len: length of IEs
7251  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
7252  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
7253  * @gfp: allocation flags
7254  *
7255  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
7256  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
7257  */
7258 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
7259 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
7260 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
7261 
7262 /**
7263  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
7264  * @wdev: wireless device
7265  * @cookie: the request cookie
7266  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7267  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
7268  *	channel
7269  * @gfp: allocation flags
7270  */
7271 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7272 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7273 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
7274 
7275 /**
7276  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7277  * @wdev: wireless device
7278  * @cookie: the request cookie
7279  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7280  * @gfp: allocation flags
7281  */
7282 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7283 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7284 					gfp_t gfp);
7285 
7286 /**
7287  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
7288  * @wdev: wireless device
7289  * @cookie: the requested cookie
7290  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
7291  * @gfp: allocation flags
7292  */
7293 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7294 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
7295 
7296 /**
7297  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
7298  *
7299  * @sinfo: the station information
7300  * @gfp: allocation flags
7301  */
7302 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7303 
7304 /**
7305  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
7306  * @sinfo: the station information
7307  *
7308  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
7309  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
7310  * the stack.)
7311  */
7312 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
7313 {
7314 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
7315 }
7316 
7317 /**
7318  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
7319  *
7320  * @dev: the netdev
7321  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7322  * @sinfo: the station information
7323  * @gfp: allocation flags
7324  */
7325 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7326 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7327 
7328 /**
7329  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7330  * @dev: the netdev
7331  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7332  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
7333  * @gfp: allocation flags
7334  */
7335 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7336 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7337 
7338 /**
7339  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7340  *
7341  * @dev: the netdev
7342  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7343  * @gfp: allocation flags
7344  */
7345 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
7346 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
7347 {
7348 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
7349 }
7350 
7351 /**
7352  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
7353  *
7354  * @dev: the netdev
7355  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7356  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
7357  * @gfp: allocation flags
7358  *
7359  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
7360  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
7361  * for some reasons, this function is called.
7362  *
7363  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
7364  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
7365  */
7366 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7367 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
7368 			  gfp_t gfp);
7369 
7370 /**
7371  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7372  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7373  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
7374  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7375  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7376  * @len: length of the frame data
7377  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7378  *
7379  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7380  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7381  *
7382  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7383  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7384  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7385  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7386  */
7387 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm,
7388 			  const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags);
7389 
7390 /**
7391  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7392  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7393  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
7394  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7395  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7396  * @len: length of the frame data
7397  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7398  *
7399  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7400  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7401  *
7402  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7403  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7404  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7405  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7406  */
7407 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
7408 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7409 				    u32 flags)
7410 {
7411 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len,
7412 				    flags);
7413 }
7414 
7415 /**
7416  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
7417  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7418  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
7419  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7420  * @len: length of the frame data
7421  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7422  * @gfp: context flags
7423  *
7424  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
7425  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
7426  * transmission attempt.
7427  */
7428 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7429 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp);
7430 
7431 /**
7432  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
7433  *                                   port frames
7434  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7435  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
7436  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
7437  * @len: length of the frame data
7438  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7439  * @gfp: context flags
7440  *
7441  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
7442  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
7443  * the transmission attempt.
7444  */
7445 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7446 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
7447 				     gfp_t gfp);
7448 
7449 /**
7450  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
7451  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7452  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
7453  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
7454  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
7455  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
7456  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
7457  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
7458  *
7459  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
7460  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
7461  * control port frames over nl80211.
7462  *
7463  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
7464  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
7465  *
7466  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
7467  */
7468 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev,
7469 			      struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted);
7470 
7471 /**
7472  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
7473  * @dev: network device
7474  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
7475  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
7476  * @gfp: context flags
7477  *
7478  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
7479  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
7480  */
7481 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7482 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
7483 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
7484 
7485 /**
7486  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
7487  * @dev: network device
7488  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7489  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
7490  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
7491  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
7492  * @gfp: context flags
7493  */
7494 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7495 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
7496 
7497 /**
7498  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
7499  * @dev: network device
7500  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7501  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
7502  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
7503  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
7504  * @gfp: context flags
7505  *
7506  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
7507  * given interval is exceeded.
7508  */
7509 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7510 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
7511 
7512 /**
7513  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
7514  * @dev: network device
7515  * @gfp: context flags
7516  *
7517  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
7518  */
7519 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
7520 
7521 /**
7522  * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
7523  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7524  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7525  * @gfp: context flags
7526  *
7527  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
7528  */
7529 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7530 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp);
7531 
7532 /**
7533  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
7534  * @dev: network device
7535  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
7536  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
7537  * @gfp: context flags
7538  *
7539  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
7540  * frame.
7541  */
7542 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
7543 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
7544 				       gfp_t gfp);
7545 
7546 /**
7547  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
7548  * @netdev: network device
7549  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7550  * @event: type of event
7551  * @gfp: context flags
7552  *
7553  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
7554  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
7555  * also by full-MAC drivers.
7556  */
7557 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7558 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7559 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
7560 
7561 
7562 /**
7563  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
7564  * @dev: network device
7565  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
7566  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
7567  * @gfp: allocation flags
7568  */
7569 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7570 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
7571 
7572 /**
7573  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
7574  * @dev: network device
7575  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
7576  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
7577  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
7578  * @gfp: allocation flags
7579  */
7580 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
7581 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
7582 
7583 /**
7584  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
7585  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7586  * @addr: the transmitter address
7587  * @gfp: context flags
7588  *
7589  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7590  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
7591  * sender.
7592  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7593  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7594  */
7595 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7596 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7597 
7598 /**
7599  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
7600  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7601  * @addr: the transmitter address
7602  * @gfp: context flags
7603  *
7604  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7605  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
7606  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
7607  * station to avoid event flooding.
7608  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7609  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7610  */
7611 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7612 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7613 
7614 /**
7615  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
7616  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
7617  * @addr: the address of the peer
7618  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
7619  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
7620  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
7621  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
7622  * @gfp: allocation flags
7623  */
7624 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7625 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
7626 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
7627 
7628 /**
7629  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
7630  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7631  * @frame: the frame
7632  * @len: length of the frame
7633  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
7634  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7635  *
7636  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7637  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7638  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7639  */
7640 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
7641 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
7642 
7643 /**
7644  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
7645  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7646  * @frame: the frame
7647  * @len: length of the frame
7648  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
7649  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7650  *
7651  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7652  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7653  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7654  */
7655 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7656 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
7657 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
7658 {
7659 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
7660 					sig_dbm);
7661 }
7662 
7663 /**
7664  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
7665  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7666  * @chandef: the channel definition
7667  * @iftype: interface type
7668  *
7669  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7670  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
7671  */
7672 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7673 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7674 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7675 
7676 /**
7677  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
7678  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7679  * @chandef: the channel definition
7680  * @iftype: interface type
7681  *
7682  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7683  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
7684  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
7685  * more permissive conditions.
7686  *
7687  * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
7688  */
7689 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7690 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7691 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7692 
7693 /*
7694  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
7695  * @dev: the device which switched channels
7696  * @chandef: the new channel definition
7697  *
7698  * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
7699  * driver context!
7700  */
7701 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7702 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
7703 
7704 /*
7705  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
7706  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
7707  * @chandef: the future channel definition
7708  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
7709  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
7710  *
7711  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
7712  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
7713  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
7714  */
7715 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7716 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7717 				       u8 count, bool quiet);
7718 
7719 /**
7720  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
7721  *
7722  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
7723  * @band: band pointer to fill
7724  *
7725  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7726  */
7727 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
7728 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
7729 
7730 /**
7731  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
7732  *
7733  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7734  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
7735  *
7736  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7737  */
7738 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7739 					  u8 *op_class);
7740 
7741 /**
7742  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
7743  *
7744  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7745  *
7746  * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
7747  */
7748 static inline u32
7749 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
7750 {
7751 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
7752 }
7753 
7754 /*
7755  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
7756  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
7757  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
7758  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
7759  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
7760  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
7761  * @gfp: allocation flags
7762  *
7763  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
7764  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
7765  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
7766  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
7767  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
7768  */
7769 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7770 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7771 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7772 
7773 /*
7774  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
7775  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
7776  *
7777  * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
7778  */
7779 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
7780 
7781 /**
7782  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
7783  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
7784  *
7785  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
7786  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
7787  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
7788  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
7789  * is unbound from the driver.
7790  *
7791  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7792  */
7793 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
7794 
7795 /**
7796  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
7797  * @dev: the netdev to register
7798  *
7799  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
7800  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
7801  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
7802  * instead as well.
7803  *
7804  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7805  */
7806 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
7807 
7808 /**
7809  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
7810  * @dev: the netdev to register
7811  *
7812  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
7813  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
7814  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
7815  * usable instead as well.
7816  *
7817  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7818  */
7819 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
7820 {
7821 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
7822 }
7823 
7824 /**
7825  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
7826  * @ies: FT IEs
7827  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
7828  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
7829  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
7830  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
7831  */
7832 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
7833 	const u8 *ies;
7834 	size_t ies_len;
7835 	const u8 *target_ap;
7836 	const u8 *ric_ies;
7837 	size_t ric_ies_len;
7838 };
7839 
7840 /**
7841  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
7842  * @netdev: network device
7843  * @ft_event: IE information
7844  */
7845 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7846 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
7847 
7848 /**
7849  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
7850  * @ies: the input IE buffer
7851  * @len: the input length
7852  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
7853  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
7854  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
7855  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
7856  *
7857  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
7858  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
7859  *
7860  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
7861  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
7862  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
7863  */
7864 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
7865 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
7866 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
7867 
7868 /**
7869  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
7870  * @ies: the IE buffer
7871  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7872  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7873  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7874  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7875  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7876  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
7877  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
7878  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7879  *
7880  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7881  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7882  * split.
7883  *
7884  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7885  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7886  *
7887  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7888  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7889  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7890  *
7891  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7892  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7893  * of the buffer should be used.
7894  */
7895 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7896 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
7897 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
7898 			      size_t offset);
7899 
7900 /**
7901  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
7902  * @ies: the IE buffer
7903  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7904  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7905  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7906  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7907  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7908  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7909  *
7910  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7911  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7912  * split.
7913  *
7914  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7915  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7916  *
7917  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7918  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7919  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7920  *
7921  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7922  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7923  * of the buffer should be used.
7924  */
7925 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7926 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
7927 {
7928 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
7929 }
7930 
7931 /**
7932  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
7933  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
7934  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
7935  * @gfp: allocation flags
7936  *
7937  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
7938  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
7939  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
7940  * else caused the wakeup.
7941  */
7942 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7943 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7944 				   gfp_t gfp);
7945 
7946 /**
7947  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
7948  *
7949  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
7950  * @gfp: allocation flags
7951  *
7952  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
7953  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
7954  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
7955  */
7956 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
7957 
7958 /**
7959  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
7960  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7961  *
7962  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
7963  */
7964 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7965 
7966 /**
7967  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
7968  *
7969  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7970  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7971  *
7972  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
7973  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
7974  * the interface combinations.
7975  */
7976 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7977 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
7978 
7979 /**
7980  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
7981  *
7982  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7983  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7984  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
7985  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
7986  *
7987  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
7988  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
7989  * purposes.
7990  */
7991 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7992 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
7993 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
7994 					    void *data),
7995 			       void *data);
7996 
7997 /*
7998  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
7999  *
8000  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8001  * @wdev: wireless device
8002  * @gfp: context flags
8003  *
8004  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
8005  * disconnected.
8006  *
8007  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
8008  */
8009 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8010 			 gfp_t gfp);
8011 
8012 /**
8013  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
8014  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
8015  *
8016  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
8017  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
8018  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
8019  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
8020  *
8021  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
8022  * the driver while the function is running.
8023  */
8024 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8025 
8026 /**
8027  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
8028  *
8029  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8030  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8031  *
8032  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8033  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8034  */
8035 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8036 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8037 {
8038 	u8 *ft_byte;
8039 
8040 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8041 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
8042 }
8043 
8044 /**
8045  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
8046  *
8047  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8048  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8049  *
8050  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8051  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8052  */
8053 static inline bool
8054 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8055 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8056 {
8057 	u8 ft_byte;
8058 
8059 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8060 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
8061 }
8062 
8063 /**
8064  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
8065  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
8066  *
8067  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
8068  */
8069 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
8070 
8071 /**
8072  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
8073  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
8074  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
8075  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
8076  *	 result.
8077  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
8078  * @inst_id: the local instance id
8079  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
8080  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
8081  * @info_len: the length of the &info
8082  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
8083  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
8084  */
8085 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
8086 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
8087 	u8 inst_id;
8088 	u8 peer_inst_id;
8089 	const u8 *addr;
8090 	u8 info_len;
8091 	const u8 *info;
8092 	u64 cookie;
8093 };
8094 
8095 /**
8096  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
8097  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8098  * @match: match notification parameters
8099  * @gfp: allocation flags
8100  *
8101  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
8102  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
8103  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
8104  */
8105 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8106 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
8107 
8108 /**
8109  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
8110  *
8111  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8112  * @inst_id: the local instance id
8113  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
8114  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
8115  * @gfp: allocation flags
8116  *
8117  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
8118  */
8119 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8120 				  u8 inst_id,
8121 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
8122 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
8123 
8124 /* ethtool helper */
8125 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
8126 
8127 /**
8128  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
8129  * @netdev: network device
8130  * @params: External authentication parameters
8131  * @gfp: allocation flags
8132  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
8133  */
8134 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
8135 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
8136 				   gfp_t gfp);
8137 
8138 /**
8139  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
8140  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8141  * @req: the original measurement request
8142  * @result: the result data
8143  * @gfp: allocation flags
8144  */
8145 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8146 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8147 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
8148 			  gfp_t gfp);
8149 
8150 /**
8151  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
8152  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8153  * @req: the original measurement request
8154  * @gfp: allocation flags
8155  *
8156  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
8157  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
8158  */
8159 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8160 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8161 			    gfp_t gfp);
8162 
8163 /**
8164  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
8165  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8166  * @iftype: interface type
8167  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
8168  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
8169  *
8170  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
8171  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
8172  * check_swif is '1'.
8173  */
8174 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
8175 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
8176 
8177 
8178 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
8179 
8180 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
8181 
8182 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
8183 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8184 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8185 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8186 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8187 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8188 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8189 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8190 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8191 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8192 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8193 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8194 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8195 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8196 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8197 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8198 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8199 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8200 
8201 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
8202 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8203 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
8204 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8205 
8206 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8207 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
8208 
8209 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8210 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8211 
8212 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
8213 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
8214 #else
8215 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
8216 ({									\
8217 	if (0)								\
8218 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
8219 	0;								\
8220 })
8221 #endif
8222 
8223 /*
8224  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
8225  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
8226  * file/line information and a backtrace.
8227  */
8228 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8229 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
8230 
8231 /**
8232  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
8233  * @netdev: network device
8234  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
8235  * @gfp: allocation flags
8236  */
8237 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8238 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
8239 				    gfp_t gfp);
8240 
8241 /**
8242  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
8243  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8244  */
8245 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8246 
8247 /**
8248  * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
8249  * @dev: network device
8250  * @gfp: allocation flags
8251  * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
8252  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
8253  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
8254  */
8255 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp,
8256 			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
8257 			      u64 color_bitmap);
8258 
8259 /**
8260  * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
8261  * @dev: network device
8262  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
8263  */
8264 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8265 						       u64 color_bitmap)
8266 {
8267 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
8268 					 NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
8269 					 0, color_bitmap);
8270 }
8271 
8272 /**
8273  * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
8274  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
8275  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
8276  *
8277  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
8278  */
8279 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8280 						       u8 count)
8281 {
8282 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
8283 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
8284 					 count, 0);
8285 }
8286 
8287 /**
8288  * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
8289  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
8290  *
8291  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
8292  */
8293 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev)
8294 {
8295 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
8296 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
8297 					 0, 0);
8298 }
8299 
8300 /**
8301  * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
8302  * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
8303  *
8304  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
8305  */
8306 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev)
8307 {
8308 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
8309 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
8310 					 0, 0);
8311 }
8312 
8313 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
8314